2003-02-04 Andrew Cagney <ac131313@redhat.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
1e698235 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
87885426
FN
34@set DATE June 2002
35
36@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37@set EDITOR /bin/ex
c906108c 38
6c0e9fb3 39@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 40
c906108c 41@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 42@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
43@dircategory Programming & development tools.
44@direntry
c906108c 45* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
46@end direntry
47
c906108c
SS
48@ifinfo
49This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
5d161b24 52This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
53of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
8a037dd7 56Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
1e698235 57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 58
e9c75b65
EZ
59Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
62Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 65
6826cf00
EZ
66(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69development.''
c906108c
SS
70@end ifinfo
71
72@titlepage
73@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 75@sp 1
c906108c
SS
76@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 78@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 79@page
c906108c
SS
80@tex
81{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 82\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
83\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85}
86@end tex
53a5351d 87
c906108c 88@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7 89Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
1e698235 901996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 91@sp 2
c906108c
SS
92Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9359 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 95ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
96
97Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
100Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 103
6826cf00
EZ
104(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107development.''
c906108c
SS
108@end titlepage
109@page
110
6c0e9fb3 111@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
112@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
c906108c
SS
114@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
5d161b24 118This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
119@value{GDBVN}.
120
1e698235 121Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
122
123@menu
124* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131* Stack:: Examining the stack
132* Source:: Examining source files
133* Data:: Examining data
e2e0bcd1 134* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
b37052ae 135* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 136* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
137
138* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141* Altering:: Altering execution
142* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 144* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
149* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 151* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
152
153* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 159* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 160* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
aab4e0ec
AC
161* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
162 how you can copy and share GDB
6826cf00 163* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
164* Index:: Index
165@end menu
166
6c0e9fb3 167@end ifnottex
c906108c 168
449f3b6c 169@contents
449f3b6c 170
6d2ebf8b 171@node Summary
c906108c
SS
172@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
173
174The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
175going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
176program was doing at the moment it crashed.
177
178@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
179these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
180
181@itemize @bullet
182@item
183Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
184
185@item
186Make your program stop on specified conditions.
187
188@item
189Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
190
191@item
192Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
193effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
194@end itemize
195
cce74817 196You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 197For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
198For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
199
cce74817 200@cindex Modula-2
e632838e
AC
201Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
202@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
c906108c 203
cce74817
JM
204@cindex Pascal
205Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
206nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
207entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
208syntax.
c906108c 209
c906108c
SS
210@cindex Fortran
211@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 212it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 213underscore.
c906108c 214
c906108c
SS
215@menu
216* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
217* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
218@end menu
219
6d2ebf8b 220@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
221@unnumberedsec Free software
222
5d161b24 223@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
224General Public License
225(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
226program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
227freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
228the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
229Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
230Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
231
232Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
233you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
234from anyone else.
235
2666264b 236@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
237
238The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
239the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
240include with the free software. Many of our most important
241programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
242texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
243when an important free software package does not come with a free
244manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
245gaps today.
246
247Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
248normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
249authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
250copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
251them from the free software world.
252
253That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
254from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
255manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
256only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
257contract to make it non-free.
258
259Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
260price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
261charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
262Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
263problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
264are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
265modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
266
267The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
268free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
269commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
270accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
271
272Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
273When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
274are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
275provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
276manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
277a changed version of the program is not really available to our
278community.
279
280Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
281acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
282author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
283authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
284to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
285may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
286with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
287are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
288of the manual.
289
290However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
291content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
292media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
293obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
294manual to replace it.
295
296Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
297lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
298free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
299the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
300realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
301the free software community.
302
303If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
304the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
305license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
306don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
307will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
308option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
309what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
310try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 311is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
312
313You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
314manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
315copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
316improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
317at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
318and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
319Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
320have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
321
322The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
323published by other publishers, at
324@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
325
6d2ebf8b 326@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
327@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
328
329Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
330other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
331development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
332of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
333to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
334file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
335blow-by-blow account.
336
337Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
338
339@quotation
340@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
341or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
342omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
343@end quotation
344
345So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
346particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
347releases:
299ffc64 348Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
c906108c
SS
349Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
350Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
351Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
352Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
353Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
354John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
355Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
356and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
357
358Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
359Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
360
b37052ae
EZ
361Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
362in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
363Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
364demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
365much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 366
b37052ae 367@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
368object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
369Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
370
371David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
372the original support for encapsulated COFF.
373
0179ffac 374Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
c906108c
SS
375
376Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
377Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
378support.
379Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
380Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
381Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
382David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
383Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
384Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
385Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
386Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
387Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
388Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
389Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
390Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
391Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
392Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
393Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
a37295f9 394Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
c906108c 395
1104b9e7 396Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
c906108c
SS
397
398Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
399libraries.
400
401Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
402about several machine instruction sets.
403
404Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
405remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
406contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
407and RDI targets, respectively.
408
409Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
410command-line editing and command history.
411
7a292a7a
SS
412Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
413Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 414
5d161b24 415Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 416He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 417symbols.
c906108c
SS
418
419Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
420Super-H processors.
421
422NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
423
424Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
425
426Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
427
428Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
429
96a2c332 430Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
431
432Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
433watchpoints.
434
435Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
436
437Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
438
439Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 440nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
441
442The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
443support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 444(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
445compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
446John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
447Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
448information in this manual.
449
b37052ae
EZ
450DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
451Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
452
96a2c332
SS
453Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
454development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
455fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
456Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
457Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
458Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
459Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
460addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
461JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
462Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
463Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
464Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
465Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
466Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
467Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c 468
e2e0bcd1
JB
469Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
470Hat.
c906108c 471
6d2ebf8b 472@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
473@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
474
475You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
476However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
477debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
478
479@iftex
480In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
481to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
482@end iftex
483
484@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
485@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
486
487One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
488processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
489quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
490definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
491session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
492then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
493same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
494@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
495procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
496
497@smallexample
498$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
499$ @b{./m4}
500@b{define(foo,0000)}
501
502@b{foo}
5030000
504@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
505
506@b{bar}
5070000
508@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
509
510@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
511@b{baz}
512@b{C-d}
513m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
514@end smallexample
515
516@noindent
517Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
518
c906108c
SS
519@smallexample
520$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
521@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
522@c FIXME... format to come out better.
523@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 524 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 525 the conditions.
5d161b24 526There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
527 for details.
528
529@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
530(@value{GDBP})
531@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
532
533@noindent
534@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
535rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
536We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
537that examples fit in this manual.
538
539@smallexample
540(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
541@end smallexample
542
543@noindent
544We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
545Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
546@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
547@code{break} command.
548
549@smallexample
550(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
551Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
552@end smallexample
553
554@noindent
555Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
556control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
557subroutine, the program runs as usual:
558
559@smallexample
560(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
561Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
562@b{define(foo,0000)}
563
564@b{foo}
5650000
566@end smallexample
567
568@noindent
569To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
570suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
571context where it stops.
572
573@smallexample
574@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
575
5d161b24 576Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
577 at builtin.c:879
578879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
579@end smallexample
580
581@noindent
582Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
583the next line of the current function.
584
585@smallexample
586(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
587882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
588 : nil,
589@end smallexample
590
591@noindent
592@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
593by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
594@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
595subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
596
597@smallexample
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
599set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
600 at input.c:530
601530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
602@end smallexample
603
604@noindent
605The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
606suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
607shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
608command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
609in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
610stack frame for each active subroutine.
611
612@smallexample
613(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
614#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
615 at input.c:530
5d161b24 616#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
617 at builtin.c:882
618#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
619#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
620 at macro.c:71
621#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
622#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
623@end smallexample
624
625@noindent
626We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
627times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
628falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
629
630@smallexample
631(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6320x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6340x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
635def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
636(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
637536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
638 : xstrdup(rq);
639(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
640538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
641@end smallexample
642
643@noindent
644The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
645@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
646and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
647(@code{print}) to see their values.
648
649@smallexample
650(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
651$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
652(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
653$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
654@end smallexample
655
656@noindent
657@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
658To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
659surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
660
661@smallexample
662(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
663533 xfree(rquote);
664534
665535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
666 : xstrdup (lq);
667536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
668 : xstrdup (rq);
669537
670538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
671539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
672540 @}
673541
674542 void
675@end smallexample
676
677@noindent
678Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
679@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
680
681@smallexample
682(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
683539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
684(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685540 @}
686(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
687$3 = 9
688(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
689$4 = 7
690@end smallexample
691
692@noindent
693That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
694@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
695@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
696the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
697any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
698assignments.
699
700@smallexample
701(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
702$5 = 7
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
704$6 = 9
705@end smallexample
706
707@noindent
708Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
709@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
710executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
711example that caused trouble initially:
712
713@smallexample
714(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
715Continuing.
716
717@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
718
719baz
7200000
721@end smallexample
722
723@noindent
724Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
725problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
726lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
727
728@smallexample
729@b{C-d}
730Program exited normally.
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
735indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
736session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
737
738@smallexample
739(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
740@end smallexample
c906108c 741
6d2ebf8b 742@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
743@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
744
745This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 746The essentials are:
c906108c 747@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 748@item
53a5351d 749type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 750@item
c906108c
SS
751type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
752@end itemize
753
754@menu
755* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
756* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
757* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
758@end menu
759
6d2ebf8b 760@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
761@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
762
c906108c
SS
763Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
764@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
765
766You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
767to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
768
c906108c
SS
769The command-line options described here are designed
770to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 771options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
772
773The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
774specifying an executable program:
775
474c8240 776@smallexample
c906108c 777@value{GDBP} @var{program}
474c8240 778@end smallexample
c906108c 779
c906108c
SS
780@noindent
781You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
782specified:
783
474c8240 784@smallexample
c906108c 785@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
474c8240 786@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
787
788You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
789to debug a running process:
790
474c8240 791@smallexample
c906108c 792@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
474c8240 793@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
794
795@noindent
796would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
797named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
798
c906108c 799Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
800complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
801debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
802``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
803will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 804
aa26fa3a
TT
805You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
806executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
807option processing.
474c8240 808@smallexample
aa26fa3a 809gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
474c8240 810@end smallexample
aa26fa3a
TT
811This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
812@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
813
96a2c332 814You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
815@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
816
817@smallexample
818@value{GDBP} -silent
819@end smallexample
820
821@noindent
822You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
823options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
824
825@noindent
826Type
827
474c8240 828@smallexample
c906108c 829@value{GDBP} -help
474c8240 830@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
831
832@noindent
833to display all available options and briefly describe their use
834(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
835
836All options and command line arguments you give are processed
837in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
838@samp{-x} option is used.
839
840
841@menu
c906108c
SS
842* File Options:: Choosing files
843* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
844@end menu
845
6d2ebf8b 846@node File Options
c906108c
SS
847@subsection Choosing files
848
2df3850c 849When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
850specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
851the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
852@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
853first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
854equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
855second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
856equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
857If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
858first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
859to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
860a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 861prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
862
863If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
864such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
865argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
866
867Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
868following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
869them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
870(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
871than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
872
d700128c
EZ
873@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
874@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
875@c it.
876
c906108c
SS
877@table @code
878@item -symbols @var{file}
879@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
880@cindex @code{--symbols}
881@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
882Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
883
884@item -exec @var{file}
885@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
886@cindex @code{--exec}
887@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
888Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
889and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
890
891@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 892@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
893Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
894file.
895
c906108c
SS
896@item -core @var{file}
897@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
898@cindex @code{--core}
899@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 900Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
901
902@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
903@item -pid @var{number}
904@itemx -p @var{number}
905@cindex @code{--pid}
906@cindex @code{-p}
907Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
908If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
909file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
910
911@item -command @var{file}
912@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
913@cindex @code{--command}
914@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
915Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
916Files,, Command files}.
917
918@item -directory @var{directory}
919@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
920@cindex @code{--directory}
921@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
922Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
923
c906108c
SS
924@item -m
925@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
926@cindex @code{--mapped}
927@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
928@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
929supported on all systems.}@*
930If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 931system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
932to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
933program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 934called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
935Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
936and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
937the symbol table from the executable program.
938
939The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
940is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
941table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 942
c906108c
SS
943@item -r
944@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
945@cindex @code{--readnow}
946@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
947Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
948the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
949This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 950
c906108c
SS
951@end table
952
2df3850c 953You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 954order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
955information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
956on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
957but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c 958
474c8240 959@smallexample
2df3850c 960gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
474c8240 961@end smallexample
c906108c 962
6d2ebf8b 963@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
964@subsection Choosing modes
965
966You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
967batch mode or quiet mode.
968
969@table @code
970@item -nx
971@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
972@cindex @code{--nx}
973@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 974Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
975@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
976options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
977files}.
c906108c
SS
978
979@item -quiet
d700128c 980@itemx -silent
c906108c 981@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
982@cindex @code{--quiet}
983@cindex @code{--silent}
984@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
985``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
986messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
987
988@item -batch
d700128c 989@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
990Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
991command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
992initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
993nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
994in the command files.
995
2df3850c
JM
996Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
997example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
998make this more useful, the message
c906108c 999
474c8240 1000@smallexample
c906108c 1001Program exited normally.
474c8240 1002@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1003
1004@noindent
2df3850c
JM
1005(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1006@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1007mode.
1008
1009@item -nowindows
1010@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1011@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1012@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1013``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1014(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1015interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1016
1017@item -windows
1018@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1019@cindex @code{--windows}
1020@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1021If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1022used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1023
1024@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1025@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1026Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1027instead of the current directory.
1028
c906108c
SS
1029@item -fullname
1030@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1031@cindex @code{--fullname}
1032@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1033@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1034subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1035number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1036displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1037recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1038the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1039and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1040@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1041frame.
c906108c 1042
d700128c
EZ
1043@item -epoch
1044@cindex @code{--epoch}
1045The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1046@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1047routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1048separate window.
1049
1050@item -annotate @var{level}
1051@cindex @code{--annotate}
1052This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1053effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1054(@pxref{Annotations}).
1055Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1056together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1057types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1058@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1059maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1060
1061@item -async
1062@cindex @code{--async}
1063Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1064@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1065special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1066commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1067run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1068MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1069suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1070control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1071(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1072operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1073yet.)
1074@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1075@c should be removed.
1076
1077When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1078uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1079@samp{-noasync} option.
1080
1081@item -noasync
1082@cindex @code{--noasync}
1083Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1084
aa26fa3a
TT
1085@item --args
1086@cindex @code{--args}
1087Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1088executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1089This option stops option processing.
1090
2df3850c
JM
1091@item -baud @var{bps}
1092@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1093@cindex @code{--baud}
1094@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1095Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1096interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1097
1098@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1099@itemx -t @var{device}
1100@cindex @code{--tty}
1101@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1102Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1103@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1104
53a5351d 1105@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1106@item -tui
1107@cindex @code{--tui}
1108Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1109The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1110showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1111(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1112Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1113(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1114
1115@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1116@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1117@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1118@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1119@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1120@c systems.
1121
d700128c
EZ
1122@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1123@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1124Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1125program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1126communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1127
da0f9dcd
AC
1128@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1129@value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1130(@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1131interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1132@samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1133are not supported.
d700128c
EZ
1134
1135@item -write
1136@cindex @code{--write}
1137Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1138is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1139(@pxref{Patching}).
1140
1141@item -statistics
1142@cindex @code{--statistics}
1143This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1144memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1145
1146@item -version
1147@cindex @code{--version}
1148This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1149no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1150
c906108c
SS
1151@end table
1152
6d2ebf8b 1153@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1154@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1155@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1156@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1157
1158@table @code
1159@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1160@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1161@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162@itemx q
1163To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1164@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1165do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1166otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1167error code.
c906108c
SS
1168@end table
1169
1170@cindex interrupt
1171An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1172terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1173returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1174character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1175until a time when it is safe.
1176
c906108c
SS
1177If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1178device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1179(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1180
6d2ebf8b 1181@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1182@section Shell commands
1183
1184If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1185debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1186just use the @code{shell} command.
1187
1188@table @code
1189@kindex shell
1190@cindex shell escape
1191@item shell @var{command string}
1192Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1193If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1194shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1195(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1196@end table
1197
1198The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1199You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1200@value{GDBN}:
1201
1202@table @code
1203@kindex make
1204@cindex calling make
1205@item make @var{make-args}
1206Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1207arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1208@end table
1209
6d2ebf8b 1210@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1211@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1212
1213You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1214name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1215@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1216key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1217show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1218
1219@menu
1220* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1221* Completion:: Command completion
1222* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1223@end menu
1224
6d2ebf8b 1225@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1226@section Command syntax
1227
1228A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1229how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1230arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1231command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1232step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1233with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1234
1235@cindex abbreviation
1236@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1237unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1238documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1239abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1240equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1241names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1242arguments to the @code{help} command.
1243
1244@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1245@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1246A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1247repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1248will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1249repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1250repeat.
1251
1252The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1253@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1254exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1255
1256@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1257output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1258(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1259@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1260repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1261
41afff9a 1262@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1263@cindex comment
1264Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1265nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1266Files,,Command files}).
1267
88118b3a
TT
1268@cindex repeating command sequences
1269@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1270The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1271commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1272then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1273for editing.
1274
6d2ebf8b 1275@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1276@section Command completion
1277
1278@cindex completion
1279@cindex word completion
1280@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1281only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1282are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1283commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1284
1285Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1286of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1287word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1288enter it). For example, if you type
1289
1290@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1291@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1292@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1293@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
474c8240 1294@smallexample
c906108c 1295(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
474c8240 1296@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1297
1298@noindent
1299@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1300the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1301
474c8240 1302@smallexample
c906108c 1303(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
474c8240 1304@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1305
1306@noindent
1307You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1308breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1309@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1310were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1311might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1312to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1313
1314If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1315@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1316characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1317@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1318example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1319begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1320just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1321function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1322example:
1323
474c8240 1324@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1325(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1326@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1327make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1328make_abs_section make_function_type
1329make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1330make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1331make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1332(@value{GDBP}) b make_
474c8240 1333@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1334
1335@noindent
1336After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1337partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1338command.
1339
1340If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1341can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1342means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1343key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1344one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@cindex quotes in commands
1347@cindex completion of quoted strings
1348Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1349parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1350its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1351situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1352@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1353
c906108c 1354The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1355name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1356overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1357by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1358may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1359that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1360that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1361word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1362@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1363@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1364when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c 1365
474c8240 1366@smallexample
96a2c332 1367(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1368bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1369(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1370@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1371
1372In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1373quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1374completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1375place:
1376
474c8240 1377@smallexample
c906108c
SS
1378(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1379@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1380(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
474c8240 1381@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1382
1383@noindent
1384In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1385you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1386completion on an overloaded symbol.
1387
d4f3574e 1388For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1389expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1390overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1391see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1392
1393
6d2ebf8b 1394@node Help
c906108c
SS
1395@section Getting help
1396@cindex online documentation
1397@kindex help
1398
5d161b24 1399You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1400using the command @code{help}.
1401
1402@table @code
41afff9a 1403@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1404@item help
1405@itemx h
1406You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1407display a short list of named classes of commands:
1408
1409@smallexample
1410(@value{GDBP}) help
1411List of classes of commands:
1412
2df3850c 1413aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1414breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1415data -- Examining data
c906108c 1416files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1417internals -- Maintenance commands
1418obscure -- Obscure features
1419running -- Running the program
1420stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1421status -- Status inquiries
1422support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1423tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1424 stopping the program
c906108c 1425user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1426
5d161b24 1427Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1428commands in that class.
5d161b24 1429Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1430documentation.
1431Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1432(@value{GDBP})
1433@end smallexample
96a2c332 1434@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1435
1436@item help @var{class}
1437Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1438list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1439help display for the class @code{status}:
1440
1441@smallexample
1442(@value{GDBP}) help status
1443Status inquiries.
1444
1445List of commands:
1446
1447@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1448@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1449info -- Generic command for showing things
1450 about the program being debugged
1451show -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the debugger
c906108c 1453
5d161b24 1454Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1455documentation.
1456Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1457(@value{GDBP})
1458@end smallexample
1459
1460@item help @var{command}
1461With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1462short paragraph on how to use that command.
1463
6837a0a2
DB
1464@kindex apropos
1465@item apropos @var{args}
1466The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1467commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1468@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1469
1470@smallexample
1471apropos reload
1472@end smallexample
1473
b37052ae
EZ
1474@noindent
1475results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1476
1477@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1478@c @group
1479set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1480 multiple times in one run
1481show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1484@end smallexample
1485
c906108c
SS
1486@kindex complete
1487@item complete @var{args}
1488The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1489for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1490command you want completed. For example:
1491
1492@smallexample
1493complete i
1494@end smallexample
1495
1496@noindent results in:
1497
1498@smallexample
1499@group
2df3850c
JM
1500if
1501ignore
c906108c
SS
1502info
1503inspect
c906108c
SS
1504@end group
1505@end smallexample
1506
1507@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1508@end table
1509
1510In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1511and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1512of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1513manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1514under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1515all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1516
1517@c @group
1518@table @code
1519@kindex info
41afff9a 1520@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1521@item info
1522This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1523program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1524with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1525registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1526You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1527@w{@code{help info}}.
1528
1529@kindex set
1530@item set
5d161b24 1531You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1532@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1533@code{set prompt $}.
1534
1535@kindex show
1536@item show
5d161b24 1537In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1538@value{GDBN} itself.
1539You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1540related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1541system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1542which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1543
1544@kindex info set
1545To display all the settable parameters and their current
1546values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1547@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1548@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1549@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1550@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1551@end table
1552@c @end group
1553
1554Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1555exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1556
1557@table @code
1558@kindex show version
1559@cindex version number
1560@item show version
1561Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1562information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1563@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1564version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1565commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1566system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1567variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1568The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1569@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1570
1571@kindex show copying
1572@item show copying
1573Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1574
1575@kindex show warranty
1576@item show warranty
2df3850c 1577Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1578if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1579
c906108c
SS
1580@end table
1581
6d2ebf8b 1582@node Running
c906108c
SS
1583@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1584
1585When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1586debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1587
1588You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1589of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1590your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1591kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1592
1593@menu
1594* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1595* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1596* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1597* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1598
1599* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1600* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1601* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1602* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1603
1604* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1605* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1606@end menu
1607
6d2ebf8b 1608@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1609@section Compiling for debugging
1610
1611In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1612debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1613is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1614variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1615and addresses in the executable code.
1616
1617To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1618the compiler.
1619
e2e0bcd1
JB
1620Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1621the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1622because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1623the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1624options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1625debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1626``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1627to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1628@option{-g} alone.
1629
c906108c
SS
1630Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1631options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1632executables containing debugging information.
1633
53a5351d
JM
1634@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1635without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1636recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1637program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1638in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1639
1640@cindex optimized code, debugging
1641@cindex debugging optimized code
1642When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1643optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1644really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1645exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1646variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1647variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1648
1649Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1650@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1651doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1652please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1653
1654Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1655@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1656format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1657
1658@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1659@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1660@section Starting your program
1661@cindex starting
1662@cindex running
1663
1664@table @code
1665@kindex run
41afff9a 1666@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1667@item run
1668@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1669Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1670You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1671argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1672@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1673(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1674
1675@end table
1676
c906108c
SS
1677If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1678supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1679that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1680@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1681
1682The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1683receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1684information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1685can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1686your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1687divided into four categories:
1688
1689@table @asis
1690@item The @emph{arguments.}
1691Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1692@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1693is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1694(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1695the arguments.
1696In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1697@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1698@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1699
1700@item The @emph{environment.}
1701Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1702use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1703environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1704your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1705
1706@item The @emph{working directory.}
1707Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1708the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1709@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1710
1711@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1712Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1713standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1714in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1715set a different device for your program.
1716@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1717
1718@cindex pipes
1719@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1720pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1721program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1722wrong program.
1723@end table
c906108c
SS
1724
1725When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1726immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1727of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1728stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1729or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1730
1731If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1732time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1733table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1734your current breakpoints.
1735
6d2ebf8b 1736@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1737@section Your program's arguments
1738
1739@cindex arguments (to your program)
1740The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1741@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1742They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1743performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1744@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1745@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1746the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1747
1748On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1749@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1750calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1751the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1752
1753@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1754@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1755
c906108c 1756@table @code
41afff9a 1757@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1758@item set args
1759Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1760@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1761with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1762using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1763it again without arguments.
1764
1765@kindex show args
1766@item show args
1767Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1768@end table
1769
6d2ebf8b 1770@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1771@section Your program's environment
1772
1773@cindex environment (of your program)
1774The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1775their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1776your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1777path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1778the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1779debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1780environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1781
1782@table @code
1783@kindex path
1784@item path @var{directory}
1785Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1786(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1787The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1788You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1789system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1790MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1791is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1792
1793You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1794working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1795use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1796@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1797@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1798@var{directory} to the search path.
1799@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1800@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1801
1802@kindex show paths
1803@item show paths
1804Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1805environment variable).
1806
1807@kindex show environment
1808@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1809Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1810your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1811print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1812your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1813
1814@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1815@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1816Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1817changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1818be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1819any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1820parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1821null value.
1822@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1823@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1824
1825For example, this command:
1826
474c8240 1827@smallexample
c906108c 1828set env USER = foo
474c8240 1829@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1830
1831@noindent
d4f3574e 1832tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1833@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1834are not actually required.)
1835
1836@kindex unset environment
1837@item unset environment @var{varname}
1838Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1839program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1840@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1841rather than assigning it an empty value.
1842@end table
1843
d4f3574e
SS
1844@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1845the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1846by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1847@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1848that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1849@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1850your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1851files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1852@file{.profile}.
1853
6d2ebf8b 1854@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1855@section Your program's working directory
1856
1857@cindex working directory (of your program)
1858Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1859working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1860The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1861from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1862working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1863
1864The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1865that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1866specify files}.
1867
1868@table @code
1869@kindex cd
1870@item cd @var{directory}
1871Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1872
1873@kindex pwd
1874@item pwd
1875Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1876@end table
1877
6d2ebf8b 1878@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1879@section Your program's input and output
1880
1881@cindex redirection
1882@cindex i/o
1883@cindex terminal
1884By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1885the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1886to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1887modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1888running your program.
1889
1890@table @code
1891@kindex info terminal
1892@item info terminal
1893Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1894program is using.
1895@end table
1896
1897You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1898redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1899
474c8240 1900@smallexample
c906108c 1901run > outfile
474c8240 1902@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1903
1904@noindent
1905starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1906
1907@kindex tty
1908@cindex controlling terminal
1909Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1910with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1911argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1912commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1913process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1914
474c8240 1915@smallexample
c906108c 1916tty /dev/ttyb
474c8240 1917@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
1918
1919@noindent
1920directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1921default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1922that as their controlling terminal.
1923
1924An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1925effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1926terminal.
1927
1928When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1929command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1930for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1931
6d2ebf8b 1932@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1933@section Debugging an already-running process
1934@kindex attach
1935@cindex attach
1936
1937@table @code
1938@item attach @var{process-id}
1939This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1940outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1941targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1942find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1943or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1944
1945@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1946executing the command.
1947@end table
1948
1949To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1950which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1951programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1952also have permission to send the process a signal.
1953
1954When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1955the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1956the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1957(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1958the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1959Specify Files}.
1960
1961The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1962process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1963with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1964you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1965can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1966process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1967attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1968
1969@table @code
1970@kindex detach
1971@item detach
1972When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1973@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1974the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1975that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1976are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1977@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1978executing the command.
1979@end table
1980
1981If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1982attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1983for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1984control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1985confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1986messages}).
1987
6d2ebf8b 1988@node Kill Process
c906108c 1989@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1990
1991@table @code
1992@kindex kill
1993@item kill
1994Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1995@end table
1996
1997This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1998running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1999is running.
2000
2001On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2002while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2003@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2004outside the debugger.
2005
2006The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2007relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2008executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2009next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2010reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2011breakpoint settings).
2012
6d2ebf8b 2013@node Threads
c906108c 2014@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
2015
2016@cindex threads of execution
2017@cindex multiple threads
2018@cindex switching threads
2019In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2020may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2021of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2022the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2023that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2024modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2025registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2026
2027@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2028programs:
2029
2030@itemize @bullet
2031@item automatic notification of new threads
2032@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2033@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2034@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2035a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2036@item thread-specific breakpoints
2037@end itemize
2038
c906108c
SS
2039@quotation
2040@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2041@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2042If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2043effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2044from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2045like this:
2046
2047@smallexample
2048(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2049(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2050Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2051see the IDs of currently known threads.
2052@end smallexample
2053@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2054@c doesn't support threads"?
2055@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2056
2057@cindex focus of debugging
2058@cindex current thread
2059The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2060threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2061control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2062This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2063program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2064
41afff9a 2065@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2066@cindex thread identifier (system)
2067@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2068@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2069@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2070Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2071the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2072form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2073whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2074LynxOS, you might see
2075
474c8240 2076@smallexample
c906108c 2077[New process 35 thread 27]
474c8240 2078@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2079
2080@noindent
2081when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2082the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2083further qualifier.
2084
2085@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2086@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
6ca652b0 2087@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
c906108c
SS
2088@c program?
2089@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2090@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2091@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2092
2093@cindex thread number
2094@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2095For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2096number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2097
2098@table @code
2099@kindex info threads
2100@item info threads
2101Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2102program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2103
2104@enumerate
2105@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2106
2107@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2108
2109@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2110@end enumerate
2111
2112@noindent
2113An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2114indicates the current thread.
2115
5d161b24 2116For example,
c906108c
SS
2117@end table
2118@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2119
2120@smallexample
2121(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2122 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2123 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2124* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2125 at threadtest.c:68
2126@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2127
2128On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2129
2130@cindex thread number
2131@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2132For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2133number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2134thread in your program.
2135
41afff9a
EZ
2136@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2137@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2138@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2139@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2140@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2141Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2142both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2143form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2144whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2145HP-UX, you see
2146
474c8240 2147@smallexample
c906108c 2148[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
474c8240 2149@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2150
2151@noindent
5d161b24 2152when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2153
2154@table @code
2155@kindex info threads
2156@item info threads
2157Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2158program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2159
2160@enumerate
2161@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2162
2163@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2164
2165@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2166@end enumerate
2167
2168@noindent
2169An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2170indicates the current thread.
2171
5d161b24 2172For example,
c906108c
SS
2173@end table
2174@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2175
474c8240 2176@smallexample
c906108c 2177(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2178 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2179 at quicksort.c:137
2180 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2181 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2182 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
474c8240 2184@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2185
2186@table @code
2187@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2188@item thread @var{threadno}
2189Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2190argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2191shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2192@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2193you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2194
2195@smallexample
2196@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2197(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2198[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2200@end smallexample
2201
2202@noindent
2203As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2204@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2205threads.
c906108c
SS
2206
2207@kindex thread apply
2208@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2209The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2210more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2211with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2212@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2213threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2214@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2215@end table
2216
2217@cindex automatic thread selection
2218@cindex switching threads automatically
2219@cindex threads, automatic switching
2220Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2221signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2222signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2223message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2224thread.
2225
2226@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2227more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2228programs with multiple threads.
2229
2230@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2231watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2232
6d2ebf8b 2233@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2234@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2235
2236@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2237@cindex multiple processes
2238@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2239On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2240programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2241function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2242parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2243set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2244will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2245will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2246
2247However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2248which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2249the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2250only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2251so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2252on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2253get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2254@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2255the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2256the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2257
53a5351d
JM
2258On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2259debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2260@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2261
2262By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2263the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2264
2265If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2266use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2267
2268@table @code
2269@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2270@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2271Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2272@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2273process. The @var{mode} can be:
2274
2275@table @code
2276@item parent
2277The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2278unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2279
2280@item child
2281The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2282unimpeded.
2283
2284@item ask
2285The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2286@end table
2287
2288@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2289Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2290@end table
2291
2292If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2293@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2294breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2295@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2296the child process's @code{main}.
2297
2298When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2299child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2300
2301If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2302call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2303use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2304argument.
2305
2306You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2307a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2308Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2309
6d2ebf8b 2310@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2311@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2312
2313The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2314program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2315trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2316
7a292a7a
SS
2317Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2318such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2319@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2320change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2321continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2322ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2323explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2324
2325@table @code
2326@kindex info program
2327@item info program
2328Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2329running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2330@end table
2331
2332@menu
2333* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2334* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2335* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2336* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2337@end menu
2338
6d2ebf8b 2339@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2340@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2341
2342@cindex breakpoints
2343A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2344the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2345control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2346breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2347Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2348should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2349program.
2350
2351In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2352breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2353a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2354is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2355not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2356arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2357
2358@cindex watchpoints
2359@cindex memory tracing
2360@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2361@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2362A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2363when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2364command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2365watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2366any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2367and watchpoints using the same commands.
2368
2369You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2370whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2371Automatic display}.
2372
2373@cindex catchpoints
2374@cindex breakpoint on events
2375A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2376when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2377exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2378different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2379catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2380other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2381@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2382
2383@cindex breakpoint numbers
2384@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2385@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2386catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2387starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2388features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2389breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2390@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2391enable it again.
2392
c5394b80
JM
2393@cindex breakpoint ranges
2394@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2395Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2396operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2397@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2398hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2399all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2400
c906108c
SS
2401@menu
2402* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2403* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2404* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2405* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2406* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2407* Conditions:: Break conditions
2408* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2409* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2410* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2411@end menu
2412
6d2ebf8b 2413@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2414@subsection Setting breakpoints
2415
5d161b24 2416@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2417@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2418@c
2419@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2420
2421@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2422@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2423@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2424@cindex latest breakpoint
2425Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2426@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2427number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2428Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2429convenience variables.
2430
2431You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2432
2433@table @code
2434@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2435Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2436When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2437C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2438@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2439
2440@item break +@var{offset}
2441@itemx break -@var{offset}
2442Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2443at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2444(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2445
2446@item break @var{linenum}
2447Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2448The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2449The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2450code on that line.
2451
2452@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2453Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2454
2455@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2456Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2457@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2458superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2459functions.
2460
2461@item break *@var{address}
2462Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2463breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2464information or source files.
2465
2466@item break
2467When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2468the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2469(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2470innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2471returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2472@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2473that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2474@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2475the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2476inside loops.
2477
2478@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2479least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2480would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2481breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2482existed when your program stopped.
2483
2484@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2485Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2486@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2487value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2488@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2489above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2490,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2491
2492@kindex tbreak
2493@item tbreak @var{args}
2494Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2495same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2496way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2497program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2498
c906108c
SS
2499@kindex hbreak
2500@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2501Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2502@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2503breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2504have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2505debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2506changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2507provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2508will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2509address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2510breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2511example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2512@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2513or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2514(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2515
2516@kindex thbreak
2517@item thbreak @var{args}
2518Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2519are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2520the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2521the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2522first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2523command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2524may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2525See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2526
2527@kindex rbreak
2528@cindex regular expression
2529@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2530Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2531@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2532matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2533breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2534the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2535them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2536
2537The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2538like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2539shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2540an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2541@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2542match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2543
b37052ae 2544When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2545breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2546classes.
c906108c
SS
2547
2548@kindex info breakpoints
2549@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2550@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2551@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2552@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2553Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2554not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2555
2556@table @emph
2557@item Breakpoint Numbers
2558@item Type
2559Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2560@item Disposition
2561Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2562@item Enabled or Disabled
2563Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2564that are not enabled.
2565@item Address
2df3850c 2566Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2567@item What
2568Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2569line number.
2570@end table
2571
2572@noindent
2573If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2574the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2575are listed after that.
2576
2577@noindent
2578@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2579number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2580convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2581the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2582listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2583
2584@noindent
2585@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2586has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2587@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2588hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2589was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2590will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2591@end table
2592
2593@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2594your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2595the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2596(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2597
2598@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2599@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2600@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2601special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2602programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2603starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2604You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2605@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2606
2607
6d2ebf8b 2608@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2609@subsection Setting watchpoints
2610
2611@cindex setting watchpoints
2612@cindex software watchpoints
2613@cindex hardware watchpoints
2614You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2615expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2616this may happen.
2617
2618Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2619hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2620program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2621times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2622catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2623culprit.)
2624
1104b9e7 2625On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2626@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2627hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2628program.
2629
2630@table @code
2631@kindex watch
2632@item watch @var{expr}
2633Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2634is written into by the program and its value changes.
2635
2636@kindex rwatch
2637@item rwatch @var{expr}
2638Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2639
2640@kindex awatch
2641@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2642Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2643by the program.
c906108c
SS
2644
2645@kindex info watchpoints
2646@item info watchpoints
2647This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2648it is the same as @code{info break}.
2649@end table
2650
2651@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2652watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2653value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2654cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2655executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2656statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2657
2658When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2659
474c8240 2660@smallexample
c906108c 2661Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
474c8240 2662@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2663
2664@noindent
2665if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2666
7be570e7
JM
2667Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2668hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2669value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2670every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2671that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2672hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2673will print a message like this:
2674
2675@smallexample
2676Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2677@end smallexample
2678
2679Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2680data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2681watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2682can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2683cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2684double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2685wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2686into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2687
2688If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2689to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2690Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2691time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2692able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2693warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2694
2695@smallexample
2696Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2697@end smallexample
2698
2699@noindent
2700If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2701
2702The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2703or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2704data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2705hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2706both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2707watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2708@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2709watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2710@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2711Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2712
2713If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2714any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2715kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2716
7be570e7
JM
2717@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2718(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2719they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2720which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2721being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2722and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2723rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2724way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2725@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2726
c906108c
SS
2727@quotation
2728@cindex watchpoints and threads
2729@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2730@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2731usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2732can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2733you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2734thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2735can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2736@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2737the expression.
53a5351d 2738
d4f3574e 2739@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2740@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2741have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2742watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2743single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2744change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2745confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2746software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2747when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2748watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2749@end quotation
c906108c 2750
6d2ebf8b 2751@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2752@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2753@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2754@cindex exception handlers
2755@cindex event handling
2756
2757You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2758kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2759shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2760
2761@table @code
2762@kindex catch
2763@item catch @var{event}
2764Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2765@table @code
2766@item throw
2767@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2768The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2769
2770@item catch
2771@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2772The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2773
2774@item exec
2775@kindex catch exec
2776A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777
2778@item fork
2779@kindex catch fork
2780A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2781
2782@item vfork
2783@kindex catch vfork
2784A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2785
2786@item load
2787@itemx load @var{libname}
2788@kindex catch load
2789The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2790@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792@item unload
2793@itemx unload @var{libname}
2794@kindex catch unload
2795The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2796of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797@end table
2798
2799@item tcatch @var{event}
2800Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2801automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2802
2803@end table
2804
2805Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2806
b37052ae 2807There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2808(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2809
2810@itemize @bullet
2811@item
2812If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2813control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2814raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2815returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2816simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2817that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2818you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2819disabled within interactive calls.
2820
2821@item
2822You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2823
2824@item
2825You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2826@end itemize
2827
2828@cindex raise exceptions
2829Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2830if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2831stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2832can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2833breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2834out where the exception was raised.
2835
2836To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2837knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2838raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2839which has the following ANSI C interface:
2840
474c8240 2841@smallexample
c906108c 2842 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2843 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2844 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
474c8240 2845@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
2846
2847@noindent
2848To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2849unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2850(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2851
2852With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2853that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2854a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2855breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2856raised.
2857
2858
6d2ebf8b 2859@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2860@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2861
2862@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2863@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2864It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2865catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2866to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2867breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2868
2869With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2870where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2871delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2872their breakpoint numbers.
2873
2874It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2875automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2876when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex clear
2880@item clear
2881Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2882selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2883the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2884breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2885
2886@item clear @var{function}
2887@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2888Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2889
2890@item clear @var{linenum}
2891@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2892Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2893
2894@cindex delete breakpoints
2895@kindex delete
41afff9a 2896@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2897@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2898Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2899ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2900breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2901confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2902@end table
2903
6d2ebf8b 2904@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2905@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2906
2907@kindex disable breakpoints
2908@kindex enable breakpoints
2909Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2910prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2911it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2912that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2913
2914You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2915the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2916or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2917@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2918catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2919
2920A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2921states of enablement:
2922
2923@itemize @bullet
2924@item
2925Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2926with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2927@item
2928Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2929@item
2930Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2931disabled.
c906108c
SS
2932@item
2933Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2934immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2935set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2936@end itemize
2937
2938You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2939watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2940
2941@table @code
2942@kindex disable breakpoints
2943@kindex disable
41afff9a 2944@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2945@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2946Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2947listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2948options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2949case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2950@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2951
2952@kindex enable breakpoints
2953@kindex enable
c5394b80 2954@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2955Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2956become effective once again in stopping your program.
2957
c5394b80 2958@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2959Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2960of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2961
c5394b80 2962@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2963Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2964deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2965@end table
2966
d4f3574e
SS
2967@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2968@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2969Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2970,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2971subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2972the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2973breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2974breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2975stepping}.)
2976
6d2ebf8b 2977@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2978@subsection Break conditions
2979@cindex conditional breakpoints
2980@cindex breakpoint conditions
2981
2982@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2983@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2984The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2985specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2986breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2987programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2988a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2989and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2990
2991This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2992situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2993when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2994by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2995@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2996
2997Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2998since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2999it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3000and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3001one.
3002
3003Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3004your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3005that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3006format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3007unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3008that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3009program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
3010breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3011conditions for the
c906108c
SS
3012purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3013(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3014
3015Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3016@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3017Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3018with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 3019
c906108c
SS
3020You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3021The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3022@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3023catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3024
3025@table @code
3026@kindex condition
3027@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3028Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3029watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3030breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3031@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3032@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3033syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3034referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3035symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3036prints an error message:
3037
474c8240 3038@smallexample
d4f3574e 3039No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 3040@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3041
3042@noindent
c906108c
SS
3043@value{GDBN} does
3044not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3045command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3046@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3047
3048@item condition @var{bnum}
3049Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3050an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3051@end table
3052
3053@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3054A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3055breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3056useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3057count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3058is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3059therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3060ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3061the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3062value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3063your program reaches it.
3064
3065@table @code
3066@kindex ignore
3067@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3068Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3069The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3070execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3071takes no action.
3072
3073To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3074a count of zero.
3075
3076When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3077breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3078@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3079Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3080
3081If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3082condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3083@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3084
3085You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3086as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3087is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3088variables}.
3089@end table
3090
3091Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3092
3093
6d2ebf8b 3094@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3095@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3096
3097@cindex breakpoint commands
3098You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3099commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3100example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3101enable other breakpoints.
3102
3103@table @code
3104@kindex commands
3105@kindex end
3106@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3107@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3108@itemx end
3109Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3110themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3111@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3112
3113To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3114follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3115
3116With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3117breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3118recently encountered).
3119@end table
3120
3121Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3122disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3123
3124You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3125use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3126that resumes execution.
3127
3128Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3129execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3130(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3131another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3132ambiguities about which list to execute.
3133
3134@kindex silent
3135If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3136usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3137be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3138then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3139see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3140meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3141
3142The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3143print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3144breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3145
3146For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3147value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3148
474c8240 3149@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3150break foo if x>0
3151commands
3152silent
3153printf "x is %d\n",x
3154cont
3155end
474c8240 3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3159you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3160of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3161erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3162to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3163so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3164command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3165
474c8240 3166@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3167break 403
3168commands
3169silent
3170set x = y + 4
3171cont
3172end
474c8240 3173@end smallexample
c906108c 3174
6d2ebf8b 3175@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3176@subsection Breakpoint menus
3177@cindex overloading
3178@cindex symbol overloading
3179
b37052ae 3180Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3181to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3182This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3183@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3184a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3185something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3186particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3187you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3188waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3189options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3190sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3191@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3192breakpoints.
3193
3194For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3195breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3196We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3197
3198@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3199@smallexample
3200@group
3201(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3202[0] cancel
3203[1] all
3204[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3205[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3206[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3207[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3208[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3209[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3210> 2 4 6
3211Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3212Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3213Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3214Multiple breakpoints were set.
3215Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3216 breakpoints.
3217(@value{GDBP})
3218@end group
3219@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3220
3221@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3222@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3223@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3224@c
3225@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3226@c
d4f3574e
SS
3227Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3228any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3229attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3230@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3231
474c8240 3232@smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3233Cannot insert breakpoints.
3234The same program may be running in another process.
474c8240 3235@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
3236
3237When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3238
3239@enumerate
3240@item
3241Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3242
3243@item
5d161b24 3244Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3245name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3246that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3247Then start your program again.
3248
3249@item
3250Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3251linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3252to nonsharable executables.
3253@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3254@c @end ifclear
3255
d4f3574e
SS
3256A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3257hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3258
3259@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3260@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3261@smallexample
3262Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3263You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3264@end smallexample
3265
3266@noindent
3267This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3268only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3269watchpoints it needs to insert.
3270
3271When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3272hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3273
3274
6d2ebf8b 3275@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3276@section Continuing and stepping
3277
3278@cindex stepping
3279@cindex continuing
3280@cindex resuming execution
3281@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3282completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3283one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3284line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3285particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3286your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3287it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3288@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3289
3290@table @code
3291@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3292@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3293@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3294@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3295@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3296@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3297Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3298any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3299@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3300ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3301@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3302
3303The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3304stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3305@code{continue} is ignored.
3306
d4f3574e
SS
3307The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3308debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3309purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3310@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3311@end table
3312
3313To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3314(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3315calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3316different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3317
3318A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3319(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3320beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3321is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3322and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3323interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3324
3325@table @code
3326@kindex step
41afff9a 3327@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3328@item step
3329Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3330line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3331abbreviated @code{s}.
3332
3333@quotation
3334@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3335@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3336@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3337@c distinction here.
3338@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3339within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3340execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3341debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3342is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3343without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3344below.
3345@end quotation
3346
4a92d011
EZ
3347The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3348line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3349@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3350to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3351the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3352called within the line.
c906108c 3353
d4f3574e
SS
3354Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3355number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3356@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3357on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3358was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3359
3360@item step @var{count}
3361Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3362breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3363@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3364
3365@kindex next
41afff9a 3366@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3367@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3368Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3369This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3370the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3371control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3372that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3373is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3374
3375An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3376
3377
3378@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3379@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3380@c
3381@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3382@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3383@c function are executed without stopping.
3384
d4f3574e
SS
3385The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3386source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3387@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3388
b90a5f51
CF
3389@kindex set step-mode
3390@item set step-mode
3391@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3392@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3393@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3394The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3395stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3396information rather than stepping over it.
3397
4a92d011
EZ
3398This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3399machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3400want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3401
3402@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3403Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3404debug information. This is the default.
3405
c906108c
SS
3406@kindex finish
3407@item finish
3408Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3409returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3410
3411Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3412,Returning from a function}).
3413
3414@kindex until
41afff9a 3415@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3416@item until
3417@itemx u
3418Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3419current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3420stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3421command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3422automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3423than the address of the jump.
3424
3425This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3426though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3427exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3428simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3429through the next iteration.
3430
3431@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3432stack frame.
3433
3434@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3435of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3436example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3437(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3438@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3439
474c8240 3440@smallexample
c906108c
SS
3441(@value{GDBP}) f
3442#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3443206 expand_input();
3444(@value{GDBP}) until
3445195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
474c8240 3446@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3447
3448This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3449generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3450start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3451written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3452to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3453expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3454statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3455
3456@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3457instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3458argument.
3459
3460@item until @var{location}
3461@itemx u @var{location}
3462Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3463reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3464the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
c60eb6f1
EZ
3465,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3466hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3467location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3468implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3469invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3470line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3471line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3472invocations have returned.
3473
3474@smallexample
347594 int factorial (int value)
347695 @{
347796 if (value > 1) @{
347897 value *= factorial (value - 1);
347998 @}
348099 return (value);
3481100 @}
3482@end smallexample
3483
3484
3485@kindex advance @var{location}
3486@itemx advance @var{location}
3487Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3488required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3489command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3490frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3491not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3492have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3493
c906108c
SS
3494
3495@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3496@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3497@item stepi
96a2c332 3498@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3499@itemx si
3500Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3501
3502It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3503instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3504instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3505Display,, Automatic display}.
3506
3507An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3508
3509@need 750
3510@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3511@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3512@item nexti
96a2c332 3513@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3514@itemx ni
3515Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3516proceed until the function returns.
3517
3518An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3519@end table
3520
6d2ebf8b 3521@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3522@section Signals
3523@cindex signals
3524
3525A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3526operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3527kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3528signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3529@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3530memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3531the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3532requested an alarm).
3533
3534@cindex fatal signals
3535Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3536functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3537errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3538program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3539@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3540fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3541
3542@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3543program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3544signal.
3545
3546@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3547Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3548@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3549(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3550but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3551You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3552
3553@table @code
3554@kindex info signals
3555@item info signals
96a2c332 3556@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3557Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3558handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3559the defined types of signals.
3560
d4f3574e 3561@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3562
3563@kindex handle
3564@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3565Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3566can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3567@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3568@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3569known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3570@end table
3571
3572@c @group
3573The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3574Their full names are:
3575
3576@table @code
3577@item nostop
3578@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3579still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3580
3581@item stop
3582@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3583the @code{print} keyword as well.
3584
3585@item print
3586@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3587
3588@item noprint
3589@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3590implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3591
3592@item pass
5ece1a18 3593@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3594@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3595can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3596and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3597
3598@item nopass
5ece1a18 3599@itemx ignore
c906108c 3600@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3601@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3602@end table
3603@c @end group
3604
d4f3574e
SS
3605When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3606program until you
c906108c
SS
3607continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3608effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3609after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3610command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3611program sees that signal when you continue.
3612
24f93129
EZ
3613The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3614non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3615@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3616erroneous signals.
3617
c906108c
SS
3618You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3619seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3620or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3621due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3622values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3623execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3624a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3625you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3626program a signal}.
c906108c 3627
6d2ebf8b 3628@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3629@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3630
3631When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3632programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3633breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3634
3635@table @code
3636@cindex breakpoints and threads
3637@cindex thread breakpoints
3638@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3639@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3640@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3641@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3642writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3643
3644Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3645to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3646particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3647numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3648column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3649
3650If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3651breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3652program.
3653
3654You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3655well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3656breakpoint condition, like this:
3657
3658@smallexample
2df3850c 3659(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3660@end smallexample
3661
3662@end table
3663
3664@cindex stopped threads
3665@cindex threads, stopped
3666Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3667@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3668allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3669switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3670underfoot.
3671
3672@cindex continuing threads
3673@cindex threads, continuing
3674Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3675executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3676like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3677
3678In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3679Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3680system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3681execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3682single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3683statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3684stops.
3685
3686You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3687continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3688thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3689first thread completes whatever you requested.
3690
3691On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3692thread to run.
3693
3694@table @code
3695@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3696Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3697locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3698current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3699mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3700``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3701stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3702when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3703function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3704like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3705thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3706@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3707
3708@item show scheduler-locking
3709Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3710@end table
3711
c906108c 3712
6d2ebf8b 3713@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3714@chapter Examining the Stack
3715
3716When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3717stopped and how it got there.
3718
3719@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3720Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3721is generated.
3722That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3723the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3724and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3725The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3726The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3727stack}.
3728
3729When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3730stack allow you to see all of this information.
3731
3732@cindex selected frame
3733One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3734@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3735particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3736your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3737special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3738interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3739
3740When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3741currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3742@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3743
3744@menu
3745* Frames:: Stack frames
3746* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3747* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3748* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3749
3750@end menu
3751
6d2ebf8b 3752@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3753@section Stack frames
3754
d4f3574e 3755@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3756@cindex stack frame
3757The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3758frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3759with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3760to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3761which the function is executing.
3762
3763@cindex initial frame
3764@cindex outermost frame
3765@cindex innermost frame
3766When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3767function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3768@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3769made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3770is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3771the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3772actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3773recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3774
3775@cindex frame pointer
3776Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3777stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3778kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3779address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3780in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3781going on in that frame.
3782
3783@cindex frame number
3784@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3785zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3786and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3787they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3788frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3789
6d2ebf8b
SS
3790@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3791@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3792@cindex frameless execution
3793Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b 3794without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
474c8240 3795@smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3796@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
474c8240 3797@end smallexample
6d2ebf8b 3798generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3799This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3800the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3801with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3802has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3803it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3804correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3805no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3806
3807@table @code
d4f3574e 3808@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3809@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3810@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3811The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3812and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3813address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3814@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3815
3816@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3817@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3818@item select-frame
3819The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3820to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3821@code{frame}.
3822@end table
3823
6d2ebf8b 3824@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3825@section Backtraces
3826
3827@cindex backtraces
3828@cindex tracebacks
3829@cindex stack traces
3830A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3831line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3832frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3833stack.
3834
3835@table @code
3836@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3837@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3838@item backtrace
3839@itemx bt
3840Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3841frames in the stack.
3842
3843You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3844character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3845
3846@item backtrace @var{n}
3847@itemx bt @var{n}
3848Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3849
3850@item backtrace -@var{n}
3851@itemx bt -@var{n}
3852Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3853@end table
3854
3855@kindex where
3856@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3857@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3858The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3859are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3860
3861Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3862The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3863print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3864line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3865counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3866line number.
3867
3868Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3869@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3870
3871@smallexample
3872@group
5d161b24 3873#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3874 at builtin.c:993
3875#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3876#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3877 at macro.c:71
3878(More stack frames follow...)
3879@end group
3880@end smallexample
3881
3882@noindent
3883The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3884value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3885code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3886
b4e9345d
DJ
3887@kindex set backtrace-below-main
3888@kindex show backtrace-below-main
3889
95f90d25
DJ
3890Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3891and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3892When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3893the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3894uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3895change this behavior.
3896
3897@table @code
3898@item set backtrace-below-main off
3899Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3900default.
3901
3902@item set backtrace-below-main
3903@itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3904Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3905
3906@item show backtrace-below-main
3907Display the current backtrace policy.
3908@end table
3909
6d2ebf8b 3910@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3911@section Selecting a frame
3912
3913Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3914whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3915selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3916of the stack frame just selected.
3917
3918@table @code
d4f3574e 3919@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3920@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3921@item frame @var{n}
3922@itemx f @var{n}
3923Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3924(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3925innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3926@code{main}.
3927
3928@item frame @var{addr}
3929@itemx f @var{addr}
3930Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3931chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3932impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3933addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3934switches between them.
3935
c906108c
SS
3936On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3937select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3938
3939On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3940pointer and a program counter.
3941
3942On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3943pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3944@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3945@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3946@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3947
3948@kindex up
3949@item up @var{n}
3950Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3951advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3952that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3953
3954@kindex down
41afff9a 3955@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3956@item down @var{n}
3957Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3958advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3959that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3960abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3961@end table
3962
3963All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3964frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3965arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3966frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3967
3968@need 1000
3969For example:
3970
3971@smallexample
3972@group
3973(@value{GDBP}) up
3974#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3975 at env.c:10
397610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3977@end group
3978@end smallexample
3979
3980After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3981prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
87885426
FN
3982You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3983editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3984@xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3985for details.
c906108c
SS
3986
3987@table @code
3988@kindex down-silently
3989@kindex up-silently
3990@item up-silently @var{n}
3991@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3992These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3993respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3994causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3995in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3996distracting.
3997@end table
3998
6d2ebf8b 3999@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
4000@section Information about a frame
4001
4002There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4003stack frame.
4004
4005@table @code
4006@item frame
4007@itemx f
4008When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4009frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4010selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4011argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4012@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4013
4014@kindex info frame
41afff9a 4015@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
4016@item info frame
4017@itemx info f
4018This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4019including:
4020
4021@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
4022@item
4023the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
4024@item
4025the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4026@item
4027the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4028@item
4029the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4030@item
4031the address of the frame's arguments
4032@item
d4f3574e
SS
4033the address of the frame's local variables
4034@item
c906108c
SS
4035the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4036@item
4037which registers were saved in the frame
4038@end itemize
4039
4040@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4041something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4042the usual conventions.
4043
4044@item info frame @var{addr}
4045@itemx info f @var{addr}
4046Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4047selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4048command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4049architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4050@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4051
4052@kindex info args
4053@item info args
4054Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4055
4056@item info locals
4057@kindex info locals
4058Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4059line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4060accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4061
c906108c 4062@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
4063@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4064@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
4065@item info catch
4066Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4067current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4068exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4069@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4070@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 4071
c906108c
SS
4072@end table
4073
c906108c 4074
6d2ebf8b 4075@node Source
c906108c
SS
4076@chapter Examining Source Files
4077
4078@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4079information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4080used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4081the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4082(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4083execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4084source files by explicit command.
4085
7a292a7a 4086If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4087prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4088@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4089
4090@menu
4091* List:: Printing source lines
87885426 4092* Edit:: Editing source files
c906108c 4093* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4094* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4095* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4096@end menu
4097
6d2ebf8b 4098@node List
c906108c
SS
4099@section Printing source lines
4100
4101@kindex list
41afff9a 4102@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4103To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4104(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4105There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4106
4107Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4108
4109@table @code
4110@item list @var{linenum}
4111Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4112current source file.
4113
4114@item list @var{function}
4115Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4116@var{function}.
4117
4118@item list
4119Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4120@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4121printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4122as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4123Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4124
4125@item list -
4126Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4127@end table
4128
4129By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4130the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4131
4132@table @code
4133@kindex set listsize
4134@item set listsize @var{count}
4135Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4136the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4137
4138@kindex show listsize
4139@item show listsize
4140Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4141@end table
4142
4143Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4144so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4145than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4146argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4147each repetition moves up in the source file.
4148
4149@cindex linespec
4150In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4151@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4152of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4153Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4154
4155@table @code
4156@item list @var{linespec}
4157Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4158
4159@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4160Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4161linespecs.
4162
4163@item list ,@var{last}
4164Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4165
4166@item list @var{first},
4167Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4168
4169@item list +
4170Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4171
4172@item list -
4173Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4174
4175@item list
4176As described in the preceding table.
4177@end table
4178
4179Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4180kinds of linespec.
4181
4182@table @code
4183@item @var{number}
4184Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4185When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4186the same source file as the first linespec.
4187
4188@item +@var{offset}
4189Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4190When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4191two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4192first linespec.
4193
4194@item -@var{offset}
4195Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4196
4197@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4198Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4199
4200@item @var{function}
4201Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4202For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4203
4204@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4205Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4206function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4207file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4208identically named functions in different source files.
4209
4210@item *@var{address}
4211Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4212@var{address} may be any expression.
4213@end table
4214
87885426
FN
4215@node Edit
4216@section Editing source files
4217@cindex editing source files
4218
4219@kindex edit
4220@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4221To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4222The editing program of your choice
4223is invoked with the current line set to
4224the active line in the program.
4225Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4226want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4227
4228Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4229
4230@table @code
4231@item edit
4232Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4233
4234@item edit @var{number}
4235Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4236
4237@item edit @var{function}
4238Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4239
4240@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4241Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4242
4243@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4244Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4245function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4246file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4247identically named functions in different source files.
4248
4249@item edit *@var{address}
4250Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4251@var{address} may be any expression.
4252@end table
4253
4254@subsection Choosing your editor
4255You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4256@footnote{
4257The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4258following command-line syntax:
10998722 4259@smallexample
87885426 4260ex +@var{number} file
10998722
AC
4261@end smallexample
4262The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4263the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4264by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4265@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4266@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4267@smallexample
87885426
FN
4268EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4269export EDITOR
4270gdb ...
10998722 4271@end smallexample
87885426 4272or in the @code{csh} shell,
10998722 4273@smallexample
87885426
FN
4274setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4275gdb ...
10998722 4276@end smallexample
87885426 4277
6d2ebf8b 4278@node Search
c906108c
SS
4279@section Searching source files
4280@cindex searching
4281@kindex reverse-search
4282
4283There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4284regular expression.
4285
4286@table @code
4287@kindex search
4288@kindex forward-search
4289@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4290@itemx search @var{regexp}
4291The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4292starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4293@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4294synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4295@code{fo}.
4296
4297@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4298The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4299with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4300for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4301this command as @code{rev}.
4302@end table
c906108c 4303
6d2ebf8b 4304@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4305@section Specifying source directories
4306
4307@cindex source path
4308@cindex directories for source files
4309Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4310files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4311the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4312session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4313this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4314it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4315in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4316the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4317the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4318path.
4319
4320If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4321object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4322too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4323compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4324last resort.
4325
4326Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4327any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4328each line is in the file.
4329
4330@kindex directory
4331@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4332When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4333and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4334To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4335
4336@table @code
4337@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4338@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4339Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4340directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4341(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4342part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4343whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4344path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4345
4346@kindex cdir
4347@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4348@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4349@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4350@cindex compilation directory
4351@cindex current directory
4352@cindex working directory
4353@cindex directory, current
4354@cindex directory, compilation
4355You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4356directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4357working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4358tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4359session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4360directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4361
4362@item directory
4363Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4364
4365@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4366@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4367
4368@item show directories
4369@kindex show directories
4370Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4371@end table
4372
4373If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4374interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4375versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4376
4377@enumerate
4378@item
4379Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4380
4381@item
4382Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4383directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4384directories in one command.
4385@end enumerate
4386
6d2ebf8b 4387@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4388@section Source and machine code
4389
4390You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4391addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4392a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4393mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4394line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4395well as hex.
4396
4397@table @code
4398@kindex info line
4399@item info line @var{linespec}
4400Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4401source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4402the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4403source lines}).
4404@end table
4405
4406For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4407the object code for the first line of function
4408@code{m4_changequote}:
4409
d4f3574e
SS
4410@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4411@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4412@smallexample
96a2c332 4413(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4414Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4415@end smallexample
4416
4417@noindent
4418We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4419@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4420@smallexample
4421(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4422Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4423@end smallexample
4424
4425@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4426@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4427After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4428is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4429sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4430,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4431convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4432variables}).
4433
4434@table @code
4435@kindex disassemble
4436@cindex assembly instructions
4437@cindex instructions, assembly
4438@cindex machine instructions
4439@cindex listing machine instructions
4440@item disassemble
4441This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4442instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4443program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4444command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4445surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4446(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4447@end table
4448
c906108c
SS
4449The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4450HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4451
4452@smallexample
4453(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4454Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
44550x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
44560x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
44570x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
44580x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
44590x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
44600x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
44610x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
44620x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4463End of assembler dump.
4464@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4465
4466Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4467mnemonics or other syntax.
4468
4469@table @code
d4f3574e 4470@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4471@cindex assembly instructions
4472@cindex instructions, assembly
4473@cindex machine instructions
4474@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4475@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4476@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4477@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4478Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4479program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4480
4481Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4482can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4483The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4484assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4485@end table
4486
4487
6d2ebf8b 4488@node Data
c906108c
SS
4489@chapter Examining Data
4490
4491@cindex printing data
4492@cindex examining data
4493@kindex print
4494@kindex inspect
4495@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4496@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4497@c different window or something like that.
4498The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4499command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4500evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4501program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4502Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4503
4504@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4505@item print @var{expr}
4506@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4507@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4508value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4509you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4510@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4511formats}.
4512
4513@item print
4514@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4515If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4516@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4517conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4518@end table
4519
4520A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4521It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4522specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4523
7a292a7a 4524If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4525fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4526command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4527Table}.
c906108c
SS
4528
4529@menu
4530* Expressions:: Expressions
4531* Variables:: Program variables
4532* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4533* Output Formats:: Output formats
4534* Memory:: Examining memory
4535* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4536* Print Settings:: Print settings
4537* Value History:: Value history
4538* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4539* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4540* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
53c69bd7 4541* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
29e57380 4542* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
16d9dec6 4543* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
a0eb71c5
KB
4544* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4545 character set than GDB does
c906108c
SS
4546@end menu
4547
6d2ebf8b 4548@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4549@section Expressions
4550
4551@cindex expressions
4552@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4553compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4554by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
e2e0bcd1
JB
4555@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4556casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4557you compiled your program to include this information; see
4558@ref{Compilation}.
c906108c 4559
d4f3574e
SS
4560@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4561the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4562you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4563memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4564
c906108c
SS
4565Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4566this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4567Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4568languages.
4569
4570In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4571expressions regardless of your programming language.
4572
4573Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4574useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4575at that address in memory.
4576@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4577
4578@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4579to programming languages:
4580
4581@table @code
4582@item @@
4583@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4584@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4585
4586@item ::
4587@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4588function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4589
4590@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4591@cindex type casting memory
4592@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4593@cindex casts, to view memory
4594@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4595Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4596memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4597pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4598a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4599normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4600@end table
4601
6d2ebf8b 4602@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4603@section Program variables
4604
4605The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4606in your program.
4607
4608Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4609(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4610
4611@itemize @bullet
4612@item
4613global (or file-static)
4614@end itemize
4615
5d161b24 4616@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4617
4618@itemize @bullet
4619@item
4620visible according to the scope rules of the
4621programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4622@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4623
4624@noindent This means that in the function
4625
474c8240 4626@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4627foo (a)
4628 int a;
4629@{
4630 bar (a);
4631 @{
4632 int b = test ();
4633 bar (b);
4634 @}
4635@}
474c8240 4636@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4637
4638@noindent
4639you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4640executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4641examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4642the block where @code{b} is declared.
4643
4644@cindex variable name conflict
4645There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4646scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4647in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4648function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4649happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4650you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4651using the colon-colon notation:
4652
d4f3574e 4653@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4654@iftex
4655@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4656@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c 4657@end iftex
474c8240 4658@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4659@var{file}::@var{variable}
4660@var{function}::@var{variable}
474c8240 4661@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4662
4663@noindent
4664Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4665static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4666make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4667to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4668
474c8240 4669@smallexample
c906108c 4670(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
474c8240 4671@end smallexample
c906108c 4672
b37052ae 4673@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4674This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4675use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4676scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4677@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4678@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4679
4680@cindex wrong values
4681@cindex variable values, wrong
4682@quotation
4683@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4684wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4685scope, and just before exit.
4686@end quotation
4687You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4688This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4689set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4690stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4691values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4692also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4693after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4694variable definitions may be gone.
4695
4696This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4697To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4698when compiling.
4699
d4f3574e
SS
4700@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4701Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4702unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4703opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4704offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4705might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4706happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4707
474c8240 4708@smallexample
d4f3574e 4709No symbol "foo" in current context.
474c8240 4710@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
4711
4712To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4713different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
0179ffac
DC
4714formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4715usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4716produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4717COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4718an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4719for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
d4f3574e
SS
4720
4721
6d2ebf8b 4722@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4723@section Artificial arrays
4724
4725@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4726@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4727It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4728same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4729dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4730program.
4731
4732You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4733@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4734operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4735and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4736of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4737the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4738argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4739following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4740example. If a program says
4741
474c8240 4742@smallexample
c906108c 4743int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
474c8240 4744@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4745
4746@noindent
4747you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4748
474c8240 4749@smallexample
c906108c 4750p *array@@len
474c8240 4751@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4752
4753The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4754with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4755subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4756Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4757(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4758
4759Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4760This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4761The value need not be in memory:
474c8240 4762@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4763(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4764$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4765@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4766
4767As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4768@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c 4769the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
474c8240 4770@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4771(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4772$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
474c8240 4773@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4774
4775Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4776moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4777actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4778of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4779to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4780variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4781interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4782instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4783structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4784in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4785
474c8240 4786@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4787set $i = 0
4788p dtab[$i++]->fv
4789@key{RET}
4790@key{RET}
4791@dots{}
474c8240 4792@end smallexample
c906108c 4793
6d2ebf8b 4794@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4795@section Output formats
4796
4797@cindex formatted output
4798@cindex output formats
4799By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4800this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4801in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4802at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4803these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4804
4805The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4806already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4807@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4808letters supported are:
4809
4810@table @code
4811@item x
4812Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4813hexadecimal.
4814
4815@item d
4816Print as integer in signed decimal.
4817
4818@item u
4819Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4820
4821@item o
4822Print as integer in octal.
4823
4824@item t
4825Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4826@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4827used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4828see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4829
4830@item a
4831@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4832@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4833Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4834the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4835where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4836
474c8240 4837@smallexample
c906108c
SS
4838(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4839$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
474c8240 4840@end smallexample
c906108c 4841
3d67e040
EZ
4842@noindent
4843The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4844@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4845
c906108c
SS
4846@item c
4847Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4848
4849@item f
4850Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4851using typical floating point syntax.
4852@end table
4853
4854For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4855
474c8240 4856@smallexample
c906108c 4857p/x $pc
474c8240 4858@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4859
4860@noindent
4861Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4862names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4863
4864To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4865you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4866expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4867
6d2ebf8b 4868@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4869@section Examining memory
4870
4871You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4872any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4873
4874@cindex examining memory
4875@table @code
41afff9a 4876@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4877@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4878@itemx x @var{addr}
4879@itemx x
4880Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4881@end table
4882
4883@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4884much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4885expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4886If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4887Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4888
4889@table @r
4890@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4891The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4892how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4893@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4894@c 4.1.2.
4895
4896@item @var{f}, the display format
4897The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4898@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4899The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4900The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4901
4902@item @var{u}, the unit size
4903The unit size is any of
4904
4905@table @code
4906@item b
4907Bytes.
4908@item h
4909Halfwords (two bytes).
4910@item w
4911Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4912@item g
4913Giant words (eight bytes).
4914@end table
4915
4916Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4917default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4918@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4919
4920@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4921@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4922memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4923it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4924@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4925@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4926other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4927the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4928starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4929a value from memory).
4930@end table
4931
4932For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4933(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4934starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4935words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4936@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4937
4938Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4939letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4940unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4941specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4942(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4943
4944Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4945and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4946@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4947including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4948alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4949Code,,Source and machine code}.
4950
4951All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4952easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4953you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4954instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4955with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4956the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4957for successive uses of @code{x}.
4958
4959@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4960The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4961in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4962would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4963subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4964@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4965examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4966@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4967the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4968
4969If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4970are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4971address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4972
6d2ebf8b 4973@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4974@section Automatic display
4975@cindex automatic display
4976@cindex display of expressions
4977
4978If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4979(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4980display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4981Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4982to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4983The automatic display looks like this:
4984
474c8240 4985@smallexample
c906108c
SS
49862: foo = 38
49873: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
474c8240 4988@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4989
4990@noindent
4991This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4992displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4993specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4994whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4995format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4996or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4997supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4998
4999@table @code
5000@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
5001@item display @var{expr}
5002Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
5003each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5004
5005@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5006
d4f3574e 5007@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 5008For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 5009count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
5010arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5011@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5012
5013@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5014For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5015number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5016be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5017doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5018@end table
5019
5020For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5021instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 5022is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5023
5024@table @code
5025@kindex delete display
5026@kindex undisplay
5027@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5028@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5029Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5030
5031@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5032(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5033
5034@kindex disable display
5035@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5036Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5037item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5038enabled again later.
5039
5040@kindex enable display
5041@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5042Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5043again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5044
5045@item display
5046Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5047done when your program stops.
5048
5049@kindex info display
5050@item info display
5051Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5052automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5053values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5054It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5055because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5056@end table
5057
5058If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5059sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5060expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5061variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5062@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5063@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5064continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5065there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5066automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5067is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5068
6d2ebf8b 5069@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
5070@section Print settings
5071
5072@cindex format options
5073@cindex print settings
5074@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5075and symbols are printed.
5076
5077@noindent
5078These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5079
5080@table @code
5081@kindex set print address
5082@item set print address
5083@itemx set print address on
5084@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5085traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5086even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5087is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5088@code{set print address on}:
5089
5090@smallexample
5091@group
5092(@value{GDBP}) f
5093#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5094 at input.c:530
5095530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5096@end group
5097@end smallexample
5098
5099@item set print address off
5100Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5101this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5102
5103@smallexample
5104@group
5105(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5106(@value{GDBP}) f
5107#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5108530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5109@end group
5110@end smallexample
5111
5112You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5113dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5114@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5115all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5116
5117@kindex show print address
5118@item show print address
5119Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5120@end table
5121
5122When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5123closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5124identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5125source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5126@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5127you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5128it prints a symbolic address:
5129
5130@table @code
5131@kindex set print symbol-filename
5132@item set print symbol-filename on
5133Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5134symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5135
5136@item set print symbol-filename off
5137Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5138default.
5139
5140@kindex show print symbol-filename
5141@item show print symbol-filename
5142Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5143line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5144@end table
5145
5146Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5147numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5148number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5149
5150Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5151printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5152
5153@table @code
5154@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5155@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5156Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5157offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5158@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5159to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5160
5161@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5162@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5163Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5164symbolic address.
5165@end table
5166
5167@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5168@cindex pointer, finding referent
5169If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5170@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5171and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5172@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5173For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5174at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5175
474c8240 5176@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5177(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5178(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5179$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
474c8240 5180@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5181
5182@quotation
5183@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5184does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5185the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5186@end quotation
5187
5188Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5189
5190@table @code
5191@kindex set print array
5192@item set print array
5193@itemx set print array on
5194Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5195but uses more space. The default is off.
5196
5197@item set print array off
5198Return to compressed format for arrays.
5199
5200@kindex show print array
5201@item show print array
5202Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5203arrays.
5204
5205@kindex set print elements
5206@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5207Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5208If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5209printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5210This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5211When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5212Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5213
5214@kindex show print elements
5215@item show print elements
5216Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5217If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5218
5219@kindex set print null-stop
5220@item set print null-stop
5221Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5222@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5223contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5224The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5225
5226@kindex set print pretty
5227@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5228Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5229per line, like this:
5230
5231@smallexample
5232@group
5233$1 = @{
5234 next = 0x0,
5235 flags = @{
5236 sweet = 1,
5237 sour = 1
5238 @},
5239 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5240@}
5241@end group
5242@end smallexample
5243
5244@item set print pretty off
5245Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5246
5247@smallexample
5248@group
5249$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5250meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5251@end group
5252@end smallexample
5253
5254@noindent
5255This is the default format.
5256
5257@kindex show print pretty
5258@item show print pretty
5259Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5260
5261@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5262@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5263Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5264@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5265character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5266best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5267high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5268
5269@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5270Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5271international character sets, and is the default.
5272
5273@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5274@item show print sevenbit-strings
5275Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5276
5277@kindex set print union
5278@item set print union on
5d161b24 5279Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5280is the default setting.
5281
5282@item set print union off
5283Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5284
5285@kindex show print union
5286@item show print union
5287Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5288structures.
5289
5290For example, given the declarations
5291
5292@smallexample
5293typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5294typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5295typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5296 Bug_forms;
5297
5298struct thing @{
5299 Species it;
5300 union @{
5301 Tree_forms tree;
5302 Bug_forms bug;
5303 @} form;
5304@};
5305
5306struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5307@end smallexample
5308
5309@noindent
5310with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5311
5312@smallexample
5313$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5314@end smallexample
5315
5316@noindent
5317and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5318
5319@smallexample
5320$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5321@end smallexample
5322@end table
5323
c906108c
SS
5324@need 1000
5325@noindent
b37052ae 5326These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5327
5328@table @code
5329@cindex demangling
5330@kindex set print demangle
5331@item set print demangle
5332@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5333Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5334(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5335linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5336
5337@kindex show print demangle
5338@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5339Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5340
5341@kindex set print asm-demangle
5342@item set print asm-demangle
5343@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5344Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5345in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5346The default is off.
5347
5348@kindex show print asm-demangle
5349@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5350Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5351or demangled form.
5352
5353@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5354@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5355@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5356@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5357Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5358represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5359
5360@table @code
5361@item auto
5362Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5363
5364@item gnu
b37052ae 5365Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5366This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5367
5368@item hp
b37052ae 5369Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5370
5371@item lucid
b37052ae 5372Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5373
5374@item arm
b37052ae 5375Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5376@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5377debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5378require further enhancement to permit that.
5379
5380@end table
5381If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5382
5383@kindex show demangle-style
5384@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5385Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5386
5387@kindex set print object
5388@item set print object
5389@itemx set print object on
5390When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5391(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5392the virtual function table.
5393
5394@item set print object off
5395Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5396virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5397
5398@kindex show print object
5399@item show print object
5400Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5401
5402@kindex set print static-members
5403@item set print static-members
5404@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5405Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5406
5407@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5408Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5409
5410@kindex show print static-members
5411@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5412Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5413
5414@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5415@kindex set print vtbl
5416@item set print vtbl
5417@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5418Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5419(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5420ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5421
5422@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5423Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5424
5425@kindex show print vtbl
5426@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5427Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5428@end table
c906108c 5429
6d2ebf8b 5430@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5431@section Value history
5432
5433@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5434Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5435@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5436Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5437(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5438When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5439since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5440symbol table.
5441
5442@cindex @code{$}
5443@cindex @code{$$}
5444@cindex history number
5445The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5446refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5447@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5448printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5449history number.
5450
5451To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5452history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5453remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5454the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5455@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5456is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5457@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5458
5459For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5460want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5461
474c8240 5462@smallexample
c906108c 5463p *$
474c8240 5464@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5465
5466If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5467to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5468
474c8240 5469@smallexample
c906108c 5470p *$.next
474c8240 5471@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5472
5473@noindent
5474You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5475command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5476
5477Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5478@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5479
474c8240 5480@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5481print x
5482set x=5
474c8240 5483@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5484
5485@noindent
5486then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5487remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5488
5489@table @code
5490@kindex show values
5491@item show values
5492Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5493This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5494values} does not change the history.
5495
5496@item show values @var{n}
5497Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5498
5499@item show values +
5500Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5501values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5502@end table
5503
5504Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5505same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5506
6d2ebf8b 5507@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5508@section Convenience variables
5509
5510@cindex convenience variables
5511@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5512@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5513exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5514setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5515of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5516
5517Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5518@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5519the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5520(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5521by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5522
5523You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5524expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5525For example:
5526
474c8240 5527@smallexample
c906108c 5528set $foo = *object_ptr
474c8240 5529@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5530
5531@noindent
5532would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5533@code{object_ptr}.
5534
5535Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5536value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5537value with another assignment at any time.
5538
5539Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5540variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5541that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5542variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5543
5544@table @code
5545@kindex show convenience
5546@item show convenience
5547Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5548Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5549@end table
5550
5551One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5552incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5553a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5554
474c8240 5555@smallexample
c906108c
SS
5556set $i = 0
5557print bar[$i++]->contents
474c8240 5558@end smallexample
c906108c 5559
d4f3574e
SS
5560@noindent
5561Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5562
5563Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5564values likely to be useful.
5565
5566@table @code
41afff9a 5567@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5568@item $_
5569The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5570the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5571commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5572set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5573and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5574except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5575to the type of @code{$__}.
5576
41afff9a 5577@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5578@item $__
5579The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5580to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5581to match the format in which the data was printed.
5582
5583@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5584@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5585The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5586the program being debugged terminates.
5587@end table
5588
53a5351d
JM
5589On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5590begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5591name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5592
6d2ebf8b 5593@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5594@section Registers
5595
5596@cindex registers
5597You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5598with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5599for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5600your machine.
5601
5602@table @code
5603@kindex info registers
5604@item info registers
5605Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
c85508ee 5606and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5607
5608@kindex info all-registers
5609@cindex floating point registers
5610@item info all-registers
5611Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
c85508ee 5612and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
c906108c
SS
5613
5614@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5615Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5616As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5617the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5618the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5619@end table
5620
5621@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5622expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5623architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5624@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5625the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5626pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5627register that contains the processor status. For example,
5628you could print the program counter in hex with
5629
474c8240 5630@smallexample
c906108c 5631p/x $pc
474c8240 5632@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5633
5634@noindent
5635or print the instruction to be executed next with
5636
474c8240 5637@smallexample
c906108c 5638x/i $pc
474c8240 5639@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5640
5641@noindent
5642or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5643one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5644memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5645stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5646stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5647regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5648see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c 5649
474c8240 5650@smallexample
c906108c 5651set $sp += 4
474c8240 5652@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
5653
5654Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5655your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5656so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5657shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5658registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5659can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5660is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5661
5662@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5663integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5664special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5665registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5666to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5667(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5668@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5669
5670Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5671means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5672the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5673sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5674coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5675programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5676cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5677that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5678prints the data in both formats.
5679
5680Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5681(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5682value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5683were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5684true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5685frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5686
5687However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5688code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5689@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5690frame makes no difference.
5691
6d2ebf8b 5692@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5693@section Floating point hardware
5694@cindex floating point
5695
5696Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5697you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5698
5699@table @code
5700@kindex info float
5701@item info float
5702Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5703point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5704floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5705the ARM and x86 machines.
5706@end table
c906108c 5707
e76f1f2e
AC
5708@node Vector Unit
5709@section Vector Unit
5710@cindex vector unit
5711
5712Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5713more information about the status of the vector unit.
5714
5715@table @code
5716@kindex info vector
5717@item info vector
5718Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5719layout vary depending on the hardware.
5720@end table
5721
29e57380 5722@node Memory Region Attributes
16d9dec6 5723@section Memory region attributes
29e57380
C
5724@cindex memory region attributes
5725
5726@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5727required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5728to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5729use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5730
5731Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5732memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5733accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5734been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5735all memory.
5736
5737When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5738to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5739
5740@table @code
5741@kindex mem
bfac230e
DH
5742@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5743Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5744attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5745special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5746(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
29e57380
C
5747
5748@kindex delete mem
5749@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5750Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5751
5752@kindex disable mem
5753@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5754Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5755A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5756It may be enabled again later.
5757
5758@kindex enable mem
5759@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5760Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5761
5762@kindex info mem
5763@item info mem
5764Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5765for each region.
5766
5767@table @emph
5768@item Memory Region Number
5769@item Enabled or Disabled.
5770Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5771Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5772
5773@item Lo Address
5774The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5775
5776@item Hi Address
5777The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5778
5779@item Attributes
5780The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5781@end table
5782@end table
5783
5784
5785@subsection Attributes
5786
5787@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5788The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5789write accesses to a memory region.
5790
5791While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5792memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5793etc. from accessing memory.
5794
5795@table @code
5796@item ro
5797Memory is read only.
5798@item wo
5799Memory is write only.
5800@item rw
6ca652b0 5801Memory is read/write. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5802@end table
5803
5804@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5805The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5806accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5807require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5808specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5809
5810@table @code
5811@item 8
5812Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5813@item 16
5814Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5815@item 32
5816Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5817@item 64
5818Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5819@end table
5820
5821@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5822@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5823@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5824@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5825@c
5826@c @table @code
5827@c @item hwbreak
5828@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5829@c @item swbreak (default)
5830@c @end table
5831
5832@subsubsection Data Cache
5833The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5834memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5835protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5836does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5837registers.
5838
5839@table @code
5840@item cache
5841Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6ca652b0
EZ
5842@item nocache
5843Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
29e57380
C
5844@end table
5845
5846@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5847@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5848@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5849@c
5850@c @table @code
5851@c @item verify
5852@c @item noverify (default)
5853@c @end table
5854
16d9dec6
MS
5855@node Dump/Restore Files
5856@section Copy between memory and a file
5857@cindex dump/restore files
5858@cindex append data to a file
5859@cindex dump data to a file
5860@cindex restore data from a file
5861@kindex dump
5862@kindex append
5863@kindex restore
5864
5865The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5866for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5867into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5868file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5869intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5870
5871@table @code
5872@kindex dump binary
5873@kindex append binary
5874@item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5875Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5876raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5877
5878@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5879Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5880raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5881
5882@item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5883Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5884
5885@item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5886Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5887
5888@kindex dump ihex
5889@item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5890Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5891intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5892
5893@item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5894Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5895
5896@kindex dump srec
5897@item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5898Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5899srec format file @var{filename}.
5900
5901@item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5902Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5903
5904@kindex dump tekhex
5905@item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5906Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5907tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5908
5909@item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5910Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5911
42f9b0a5 5912@item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
16d9dec6
MS
5913Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5914command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5915raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5916@var{binary} after the filename.
5917
5918If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5919contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5920they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5921a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5922from that location.
5923
5924If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5925file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5926These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5927the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5928
5929@end table
5930
a0eb71c5
KB
5931@node Character Sets
5932@section Character Sets
5933@cindex character sets
5934@cindex charset
5935@cindex translating between character sets
5936@cindex host character set
5937@cindex target character set
5938
5939If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5940represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5941@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5942you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5943character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5944@dfn{target character set}.
5945
5946For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5947uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5948remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5949running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5950then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5951@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5952target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5953@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5954character and string literals in expressions.
5955
5956@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5957the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5958target-charset} command, described below.
5959
5960Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5961support:
5962
5963@table @code
5964@item set target-charset @var{charset}
5965@kindex set target-charset
5966Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5967character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5968@code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5969the character sets it supports.
5970@end table
5971
5972@table @code
5973@item set host-charset @var{charset}
5974@kindex set host-charset
5975Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5976
5977By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5978system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5979@code{set host-charset} command.
5980
5981@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5982set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5983indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5984@code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5985character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5986it can use as a host character set.
5987
5988@item set charset @var{charset}
5989@kindex set charset
5990Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5991invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5992character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5993sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
5994asterisk (@samp{*}).
5995
5996@item show charset
5997@itemx show host-charset
5998@itemx show target-charset
5999@kindex show charset
6000@kindex show host-charset
6001@kindex show target-charset
6002Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
6003and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
6004charset}.
6005
6006@end table
6007
6008@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6009sets:
6010
6011@table @code
6012
6013@item ASCII
6014@cindex ASCII character set
6015Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6016character set.
6017
6018@item ISO-8859-1
6019@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6020@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6021The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
6022characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6023this as its host character set.
6024
6025@item EBCDIC-US
6026@itemx IBM1047
6027@cindex EBCDIC character set
6028@cindex IBM1047 character set
6029Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6030mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6031@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6032
6033@end table
6034
6035Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6036GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6037encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6038
6039Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6040Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6041@file{charset-test.c}:
6042
6043@smallexample
6044#include <stdio.h>
6045
6046char ascii_hello[]
6047 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6048 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6049char ibm1047_hello[]
6050 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6051 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6052
6053main ()
6054@{
6055 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6056@}
10998722 6057@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6058
6059In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6060containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6061encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6062
6063We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6064
6065@smallexample
6066$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6067$ gdb -nw charset-test
6068GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6069Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6070@dots{}
6071(gdb)
10998722 6072@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6073
6074We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6075@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6076strings:
6077
6078@smallexample
6079(gdb) show charset
6080The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6081(gdb)
10998722 6082@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6083
6084For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6085initial character set:
6086@smallexample
6087(gdb) set charset ascii
6088(gdb) show charset
6089The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6090(gdb)
10998722 6091@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6092
6093Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6094host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6095characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6096them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6097@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6098
6099@smallexample
6100(gdb) print ascii_hello
6101$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6102(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6103$2 = 72 'H'
6104(gdb)
10998722 6105@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6106
6107@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6108literals you use in expressions:
6109
6110@smallexample
6111(gdb) print '+'
6112$3 = 43 '+'
6113(gdb)
10998722 6114@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6115
6116The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6117character.
6118
6119@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6120target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6121character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6122
6123@smallexample
6124(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6125$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6126(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6127$5 = 200 '\310'
6128(gdb)
10998722 6129@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6130
6131If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6132@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6133
6134@smallexample
6135(gdb) set target-charset
6136Valid character sets are:
6137 ascii *
6138 iso-8859-1 *
6139 ebcdic-us
6140 ibm1047
6141* - can be used as a host character set
10998722 6142@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6143
6144We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6145program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6146@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6147target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6148@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6149
6150@smallexample
6151(gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6152(gdb) show charset
6153The current host character set is `ascii'.
6154The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6155(gdb) print ascii_hello
6156$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6157(gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6158$7 = 72 '\110'
6159(gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6160$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6161(gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6162$9 = 200 'H'
6163(gdb)
10998722 6164@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6165
6166As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6167string literals you use in expressions:
6168
6169@smallexample
6170(gdb) print '+'
6171$10 = 78 '+'
6172(gdb)
10998722 6173@end smallexample
a0eb71c5
KB
6174
6175The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6176character.
6177
6178
e2e0bcd1
JB
6179@node Macros
6180@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6181
6182Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6183``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6184@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6185the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6186where it was defined.
6187
6188You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6189with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6190include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6191with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6192
6193A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6194and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6195points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6196no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6197uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6198@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6199see @ref{List}.
6200
6201At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6202token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6203variable-arity macros.
6204
6205Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6206macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6207the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6208
6209@table @code
6210
6211@kindex macro expand
6212@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6213@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6214@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6215@item macro expand @var{expression}
6216@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6217Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6218@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6219not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6220it can be any string of tokens.
6221
6222@kindex macro expand-once
6223@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6224@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6225@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6226expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6227@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6228left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6229particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6230expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6231parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6232can be any string of tokens.
6233
475b0867 6234@kindex info macro
e2e0bcd1
JB
6235@cindex macro definition, showing
6236@cindex definition, showing a macro's
475b0867 6237@item info macro @var{macro}
e2e0bcd1
JB
6238Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6239source location where that definition was established.
6240
6241@kindex macro define
6242@cindex user-defined macros
6243@cindex defining macros interactively
6244@cindex macros, user-defined
6245@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6246@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6247@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6248preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6249by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6250command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6251second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6252given in @var{arglist}.
6253
6254A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6255evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6256undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6257definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6258well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6259
6260@kindex macro undef
6261@item macro undef @var{macro}
6262@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6263definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6264definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6265above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6266debugged.
6267
6268@end table
6269
6270@cindex macros, example of debugging with
6271Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6272show our source files:
6273
6274@smallexample
6275$ cat sample.c
6276#include <stdio.h>
6277#include "sample.h"
6278
6279#define M 42
6280#define ADD(x) (M + x)
6281
6282main ()
6283@{
6284#define N 28
6285 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6286#undef N
6287 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6288#define N 1729
6289 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6290@}
6291$ cat sample.h
6292#define Q <
6293$
6294@end smallexample
6295
6296Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6297We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6298compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6299information.
6300
6301@smallexample
6302$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6303$
6304@end smallexample
6305
6306Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6307
6308@smallexample
6309$ gdb -nw sample
6310GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6311Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6312GDB is free software, @dots{}
6313(gdb)
6314@end smallexample
6315
6316We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6317program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6318to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6319
6320@smallexample
6321(gdb) list main
63223
63234 #define M 42
63245 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
63256
63267 main ()
63278 @{
63289 #define N 28
632910 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
633011 #undef N
633112 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6332(gdb) info macro ADD
e2e0bcd1
JB
6333Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6334#define ADD(x) (M + x)
475b0867 6335(gdb) info macro Q
e2e0bcd1
JB
6336Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6337 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6338#define Q <
6339(gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6340expands to: (42 + 1)
6341(gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6342expands to: once (M + 1)
6343(gdb)
6344@end smallexample
6345
6346In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6347the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6348@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6349which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6350
6351Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6352the source line of the current stack frame:
6353
6354@smallexample
6355(gdb) break main
6356Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6357(gdb) run
6358Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6359
6360Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
636110 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6362(gdb)
6363@end smallexample
6364
6365At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6366
6367@smallexample
475b0867 6368(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6369Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6370#define N 28
6371(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6372expands to: 28 < 42
6373(gdb) print N Q M
6374$1 = 1
6375(gdb)
6376@end smallexample
6377
6378As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6379give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6380thereof) in force at each point:
6381
6382@smallexample
6383(gdb) next
6384Hello, world!
638512 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
475b0867 6386(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6387The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6388at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6389(gdb) next
6390We're so creative.
639114 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
475b0867 6392(gdb) info macro N
e2e0bcd1
JB
6393Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6394#define N 1729
6395(gdb) macro expand N Q M
6396expands to: 1729 < 42
6397(gdb) print N Q M
6398$2 = 0
6399(gdb)
6400@end smallexample
6401
6402
b37052ae
EZ
6403@node Tracepoints
6404@chapter Tracepoints
6405@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6406@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6407
6408@cindex tracepoints
6409In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6410the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6411anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6412depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6413might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6414fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6415to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6416
6417Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6418specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6419arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6420Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6421those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6422expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6423for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6424a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6425in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6426values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6427unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6428
6429The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
6430targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6431to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6432stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6433tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
6434
6435This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6436
6437@menu
6438* Set Tracepoints::
6439* Analyze Collected Data::
6440* Tracepoint Variables::
6441@end menu
6442
6443@node Set Tracepoints
6444@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6445
6446Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6447tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6448tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6449breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6450one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6451tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6452work on.
6453
6454For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6455of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6456it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6457local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6458commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6459tracepoint was hit.
6460
6461This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6462conditions and actions.
6463
6464@menu
6465* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6466* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6467* Tracepoint Passcounts::
6468* Tracepoint Actions::
6469* Listing Tracepoints::
6470* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6471@end menu
6472
6473@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6474@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6475
6476@table @code
6477@cindex set tracepoint
6478@kindex trace
6479@item trace
6480The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6481Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6482the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6483defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6484debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6485program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6486doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6487cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6488running.
6489
6490Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6491
6492@smallexample
6493(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6494
6495(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6496
6497(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6498
6499(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6500
6501(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6502@end smallexample
6503
6504@noindent
6505You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6506
6507@vindex $tpnum
6508@cindex last tracepoint number
6509@cindex recent tracepoint number
6510@cindex tracepoint number
6511The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6512of the most recently set tracepoint.
6513
6514@kindex delete tracepoint
6515@cindex tracepoint deletion
6516@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6517Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6518default is to delete all tracepoints.
6519
6520Examples:
6521
6522@smallexample
6523(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6524
6525(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6526@end smallexample
6527
6528@noindent
6529You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6530@end table
6531
6532@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6533@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6534
6535@table @code
6536@kindex disable tracepoint
6537@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6538Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6539@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6540the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6541a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6542
6543@kindex enable tracepoint
6544@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6545Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6546tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6547run.
6548@end table
6549
6550@node Tracepoint Passcounts
6551@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6552
6553@table @code
6554@kindex passcount
6555@cindex tracepoint pass count
6556@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6557Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6558automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6559@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6560the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6561@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6562passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6563given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6564user.
6565
6566Examples:
6567
6568@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
6569(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6570@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
6571
6572(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 6573@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
6574(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6575(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6576(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6577(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6578(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6579(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
6580@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6581@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6582@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
6583@end smallexample
6584@end table
6585
6586@node Tracepoint Actions
6587@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6588
6589@table @code
6590@kindex actions
6591@cindex tracepoint actions
6592@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6593This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6594tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6595specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6596recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6597@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6598actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6599terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6600far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6601@code{while-stepping}.
6602
6603@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6604To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6605and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6606
6607@smallexample
6608(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6609
6826cf00 6610(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 6611
6826cf00 6612(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
6613@end smallexample
6614
6615In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6616commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6617hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6618following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6619followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6620@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6621@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6622@code{end} command.
6623
6624@smallexample
6625(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6626(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6627Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6628> collect bar,baz
6629> collect $regs
6630> while-stepping 12
6631 > collect $fp, $sp
6632 > end
6633end
6634@end smallexample
6635
6636@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6637@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6638Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6639This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6640In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6641special arguments are supported:
6642
6643@table @code
6644@item $regs
6645collect all registers
6646
6647@item $args
6648collect all function arguments
6649
6650@item $locals
6651collect all local variables.
6652@end table
6653
6654You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6655with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6656arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6657
f5c37c66
EZ
6658The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6659particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6660
b37052ae
EZ
6661@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6662@item while-stepping @var{n}
6663Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6664new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6665followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6666its own @code{end} command):
6667
6668@smallexample
6669> while-stepping 12
6670 > collect $regs, myglobal
6671 > end
6672>
6673@end smallexample
6674
6675@noindent
6676You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6677@code{stepping}.
6678@end table
6679
6680@node Listing Tracepoints
6681@subsection Listing Tracepoints
6682
6683@table @code
6684@kindex info tracepoints
6685@cindex information about tracepoints
6686@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 6687Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 6688a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
6689defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6690shown:
6691
6692@itemize @bullet
6693@item
6694its number
6695@item
6696whether it is enabled or disabled
6697@item
6698its address
6699@item
6700its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6701@item
6702its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6703@item
6704where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6705@item
6706its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6707@end itemize
6708
6709@smallexample
6710(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6711Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
67121 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
67132 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
67143 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6715(@value{GDBP})
6716@end smallexample
6717
6718@noindent
6719This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6720@end table
6721
6722@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6723@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6724
6725@table @code
6726@kindex tstart
6727@cindex start a new trace experiment
6728@cindex collected data discarded
6729@item tstart
6730This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6731begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6732the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6733experiment.
6734
6735@kindex tstop
6736@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6737@item tstop
6738This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6739stops collecting data.
6740
6741@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6742automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6743(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6744
6745@kindex tstatus
6746@cindex status of trace data collection
6747@cindex trace experiment, status of
6748@item tstatus
6749This command displays the status of the current trace data
6750collection.
6751@end table
6752
6753Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6754
6755@smallexample
6756(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6757(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6758Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6759> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6760> while-stepping 11
6761 > collect $regs
6762 > end
6763> end
6764(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6765 [time passes @dots{}]
6766(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6767@end smallexample
6768
6769
6770@node Analyze Collected Data
6771@section Using the collected data
6772
6773After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6774for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6775collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6776snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6777consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6778examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6779specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6780snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6781registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6782rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6783debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6784(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6785behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6786when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6787the buffer will fail.
6788
6789@menu
6790* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6791* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6792* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6793@end menu
6794
6795@node tfind
6796@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6797
6798@kindex tfind
6799@cindex select trace snapshot
6800@cindex find trace snapshot
6801The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6802@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6803counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6804snapshot is selected.
6805
6806Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6807
6808@table @code
6809@item tfind start
6810Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6811@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6812
6813@item tfind none
6814Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6815
6816@item tfind end
6817Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6818
6819@item tfind
6820No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6821
6822@item tfind -
6823Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6824retracing earlier steps.
6825
6826@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6827Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6828proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6829argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6830for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6831
6832@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6833Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6834program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6835snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6836snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6837
6838@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6839Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6840addresses.
6841
6842@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6843Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6844@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6845
6846@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6847Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6848the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6849that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6850trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6851next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6852@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6853stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6854@end table
6855
6856The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6857designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6858instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6859snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6860trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6861simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6862snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6863@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6864The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6865for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6866no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6867(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6868no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6869tracepoint as the current one.
6870
6871In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6872these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6873scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6874you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6875registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6876
6877@smallexample
6878(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6879(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6880> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6881 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6882> tfind
6883> end
6884
6885Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6886Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6887Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6888Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6889Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6890Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6891Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6892Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6893Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6894Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6895Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6896@end smallexample
6897
6898Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6899the buffer:
6900
6901@smallexample
6902(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6903(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6904> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6905> tfind line
6906> end
6907
6908Frame 0, X = 1
6909Frame 7, X = 2
6910Frame 13, X = 255
6911@end smallexample
6912
6913@node tdump
6914@subsection @code{tdump}
6915@kindex tdump
6916@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6917@cindex tracepoint data, display
6918
6919This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6920the current trace snapshot.
6921
6922@smallexample
6923(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6924(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6925Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6926> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6927> end
6928
6929(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6930
6931(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6932#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6933at gdb_test.c:444
6934444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6935
6936(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6937Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6938d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6939d1 0x18 24
6940d2 0x80 128
6941d3 0x33 51
6942d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6943d5 0x22 34
6944d6 0xe0 224
6945d7 0x380035 3670069
6946a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6947a1 0x3000668 50333288
6948a2 0x100 256
6949a3 0x322000 3284992
6950a4 0x3000698 50333336
6951a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6952fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6953sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6954ps 0x0 0
6955pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6956fpcontrol 0x0 0
6957fpstatus 0x0 0
6958fpiaddr 0x0 0
6959p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6960p1 = (void *) 0x11
6961p2 = (void *) 0x22
6962p3 = (void *) 0x33
6963p4 = (void *) 0x44
6964p5 = (void *) 0x55
6965p6 = (void *) 0x66
6966gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6967
6968(@value{GDBP})
6969@end smallexample
6970
6971@node save-tracepoints
6972@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6973@kindex save-tracepoints
6974@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6975
6976This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6977their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6978suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6979tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6980Files}).
6981
6982@node Tracepoint Variables
6983@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6984@cindex tracepoint variables
6985@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6986
6987@table @code
6988@vindex $trace_frame
6989@item (int) $trace_frame
6990The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6991snapshot is selected.
6992
6993@vindex $tracepoint
6994@item (int) $tracepoint
6995The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6996
6997@vindex $trace_line
6998@item (int) $trace_line
6999The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7000
7001@vindex $trace_file
7002@item (char []) $trace_file
7003The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7004
7005@vindex $trace_func
7006@item (char []) $trace_func
7007The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7008@end table
7009
7010Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7011use @code{output} instead.
7012
7013Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7014stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7015data.
7016
7017@smallexample
7018(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7019
7020(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7021> output $trace_file
7022> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7023> tfind
7024> end
7025@end smallexample
7026
df0cd8c5
JB
7027@node Overlays
7028@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7029@cindex overlays
7030
7031If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7032memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7033problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7034use overlays.
7035
7036@menu
7037* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7038* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7039* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7040 mapped by asking the inferior.
7041* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7042@end menu
7043
7044@node How Overlays Work
7045@section How Overlays Work
7046@cindex mapped overlays
7047@cindex unmapped overlays
7048@cindex load address, overlay's
7049@cindex mapped address
7050@cindex overlay area
7051
7052Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7053kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7054other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7055management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7056adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7057
7058One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7059independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7060@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7061their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7062instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7063largest overlay as well.
7064
7065Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7066overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7067for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7068there.
7069
c928edc0
AC
7070@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7071@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7072@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7073
474c8240 7074@smallexample
df0cd8c5 7075@group
c928edc0
AC
7076 Data Instruction Larger
7077Address Space Address Space Address Space
7078+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7079| | | | | |
7080+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7081| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7082| variables | | program | | +-----------+
7083| and heap | | | | | |
7084+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7085| | +-----------+ | | | load address
7086+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7087 | | | | | |
7088 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7089 address | | | | | |
7090 | overlay | <-' | | |
7091 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7092 | | <---. | | load address
7093 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7094 | | | |
7095 +-----------+ | |
7096 +-----------+
7097 | |
7098 +-----------+
7099
7100 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
df0cd8c5 7101@end group
474c8240 7102@end smallexample
df0cd8c5 7103
c928edc0
AC
7104The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7105and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7106its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7107Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7108may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7109data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7110program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7111program and the overlay area.
df0cd8c5
JB
7112
7113An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7114@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7115instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7116in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7117is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7118the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7119called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7120
7121Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7122program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7123global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7124
7125@itemize @bullet
7126
7127@item
7128Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7129must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7130return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7131overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7132
7133@item
7134If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7135will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7136your program's performance.
7137
7138@item
7139The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7140overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7141mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7142and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7143You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7144addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7145ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7146
7147@item
7148The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7149to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7150instruction and data spaces.
7151
7152@end itemize
7153
7154The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7155improved in many ways:
7156
7157@itemize @bullet
7158
7159@item
7160If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7161hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7162contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7163This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7164area in the usual way.
7165
7166@item
7167If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7168overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7169
7170@item
7171You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7172general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7173code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7174return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7175the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7176must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7177different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7178
7179@end itemize
7180
7181
7182@node Overlay Commands
7183@section Overlay Commands
7184
7185To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7186correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7187virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7188mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7189@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7190variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7191
7192@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7193you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7194
7195@table @code
7196@item overlay off
7197@kindex overlay off
7198Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7199disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7200always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7201overlay support is disabled.
7202
7203@item overlay manual
7204@kindex overlay manual
7205@cindex manual overlay debugging
7206Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7207relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7208using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7209commands described below.
7210
7211@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7212@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7213@kindex overlay map-overlay
7214@cindex map an overlay
7215Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7216be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7217overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7218functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7219that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7220@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7221
7222@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7223@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7224@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7225@cindex unmap an overlay
7226Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7227must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7228When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7229overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7230
7231@item overlay auto
7232@kindex overlay auto
7233Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7234consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7235to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7236Overlay Debugging}.
7237
7238@item overlay load-target
7239@itemx overlay load
7240@kindex overlay load-target
7241@cindex reloading the overlay table
7242Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7243re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7244stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7245overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7246useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7247
7248@item overlay list-overlays
7249@itemx overlay list
7250@cindex listing mapped overlays
7251Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7252addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7253
7254@end table
7255
7256Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7257of the function the address falls in:
7258
474c8240 7259@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7260(gdb) print main
7261$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
474c8240 7262@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7263@noindent
7264When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7265unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7266asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7267unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7268
474c8240 7269@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7270(gdb) overlay list
7271No sections are mapped.
7272(gdb) print foo
7273$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
474c8240 7274@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7275@noindent
7276When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7277name normally:
7278
474c8240 7279@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7280(gdb) overlay list
7281Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7282 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7283(gdb) print foo
7284$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
474c8240 7285@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7286
7287When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7288address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7289overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7290@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7291code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7292
7293@itemize @bullet
7294@item
7295@cindex breakpoints in overlays
7296@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7297You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7298@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7299@item
7300@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7301unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7302overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7303you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7304breakpoints properly.
7305@end itemize
7306
7307
7308@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7309@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7310@cindex automatic overlay debugging
7311
7312@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7313are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7314inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7315@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7316looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7317current state of the overlays.
7318
7319Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7320@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7321
7322@table @asis
7323
7324@item @code{_ovly_table}:
7325This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7326
474c8240 7327@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7328struct
7329@{
7330 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7331 unsigned long vma;
7332
7333 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7334 unsigned long size;
7335
7336 /* The overlay's load address. */
7337 unsigned long lma;
7338
7339 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7340 zero otherwise. */
7341 unsigned long mapped;
7342@}
474c8240 7343@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7344
7345@item @code{_novlys}:
7346This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7347number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7348
7349@end table
7350
7351To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7352looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7353@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7354executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7355the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7356currently mapped.
7357
81d46470 7358In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
def71bfa 7359@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
81d46470
MS
7360will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7361calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7362will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7363are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7364in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7365overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7366are not being executed.
df0cd8c5
JB
7367
7368@node Overlay Sample Program
7369@section Overlay Sample Program
7370@cindex overlay example program
7371
7372When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7373at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7374addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7375Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7376since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7377architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7378portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7379
7380However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7381program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7382suite. The program consists of the following files from
7383@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7384
7385@table @file
7386@item overlays.c
7387The main program file.
7388@item ovlymgr.c
7389A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7390@item foo.c
7391@itemx bar.c
7392@itemx baz.c
7393@itemx grbx.c
7394Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7395@item d10v.ld
7396@itemx m32r.ld
7397Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7398and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7399@end table
7400
7401You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7402cross-compiler like this:
7403
474c8240 7404@smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7405$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7406$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7407$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7408$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7409$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7410$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7411$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7412 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
474c8240 7413@end smallexample
df0cd8c5
JB
7414
7415The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7416you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7417target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7418
7419
6d2ebf8b 7420@node Languages
c906108c
SS
7421@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7422@cindex languages
7423
c906108c
SS
7424Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7425rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7426dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7427Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 7428represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 7429@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
7430
7431@cindex working language
7432Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7433allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7434native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7435consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7436language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7437language}.
7438
7439@menu
7440* Setting:: Switching between source languages
7441* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 7442* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
7443* Support:: Supported languages
7444@end menu
7445
6d2ebf8b 7446@node Setting
c906108c
SS
7447@section Switching between source languages
7448
7449There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7450set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7451@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7452defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7453used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7454are printed, etc.
7455
7456In addition to the working language, every source file that
7457@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7458file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7459source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7460language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 7461controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 7462show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
7463set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7464set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7465Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
7466
7467This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 7468as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
7469another language. In that case, make the
7470program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7471@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7472program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7473
7474@menu
7475* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7476* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7477* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7478@end menu
7479
6d2ebf8b 7480@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
7481@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7482
7483If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7484@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7485
7486@table @file
7487
7488@item .c
7489C source file
7490
7491@item .C
7492@itemx .cc
7493@itemx .cp
7494@itemx .cpp
7495@itemx .cxx
7496@itemx .c++
b37052ae 7497C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
7498
7499@item .f
7500@itemx .F
7501Fortran source file
7502
c906108c
SS
7503@item .mod
7504Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
7505
7506@item .s
7507@itemx .S
7508Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7509@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7510@end table
7511
7512In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7513extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7514
6d2ebf8b 7515@node Manually
c906108c
SS
7516@subsection Setting the working language
7517
7518If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7519expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7520your program.
7521
7522@kindex set language
7523If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7524command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 7525a language, such as
c906108c 7526@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
7527For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7528
c906108c
SS
7529Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7530language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7531to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7532source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7533languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7534source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7535command such as:
7536
474c8240 7537@smallexample
c906108c 7538print a = b + c
474c8240 7539@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7540
7541@noindent
7542might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7543@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7544printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7545@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 7546
6d2ebf8b 7547@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
7548@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7549
7550To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7551@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7552then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7553frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7554working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7555frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7556or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7557does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7558not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7559
7560This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7561entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7562written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7563a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7564case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7565
6d2ebf8b 7566@node Show
c906108c 7567@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
7568
7569The following commands help you find out which language is the
7570working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7571
7572@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
7573@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7574@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
7575@table @code
7576@item show language
7577Display the current working language. This is the
7578language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7579build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7580
7581@item info frame
5d161b24 7582Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 7583working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 7584@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7585information listed here.
7586
7587@item info source
7588Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 7589@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
7590information listed here.
7591@end table
7592
7593In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7594not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7595with a language explicitly:
7596
7597@kindex set extension-language
7598@kindex info extensions
7599@table @code
7600@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7601Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7602the source language @var{language}.
7603
7604@item info extensions
7605List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7606@end table
7607
6d2ebf8b 7608@node Checks
c906108c
SS
7609@section Type and range checking
7610
7611@quotation
7612@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7613checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7614section documents the intended facilities.
7615@end quotation
7616@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7617
7618Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7619errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7620checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7621sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7622these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7623by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7624errors when your program is running.
7625
7626@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7627Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7628can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7629the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7630@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7631your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7632for the default settings of supported languages.
7633
7634@menu
7635* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7636* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7637@end menu
7638
7639@cindex type checking
7640@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 7641@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
7642@subsection An overview of type checking
7643
7644Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7645arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7646otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7647errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7648
7649@smallexample
76501 + 2 @result{} 3
7651@exdent but
7652@error{} 1 + 2.3
7653@end smallexample
7654
7655The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7656type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7657
5d161b24
DB
7658For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7659@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7660to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7661or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
7662but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7663these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7664also issues a warning.
7665
5d161b24
DB
7666Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7667related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7668For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7669a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7670with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
7671the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7672
7673Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7674instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7675operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7676represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7677operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7678details on specific languages.
7679
7680@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7681
d4f3574e 7682@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
7683@kindex set check type
7684@kindex show check type
7685@table @code
7686@item set check type auto
7687Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7688@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7689each language.
7690
7691@item set check type on
7692@itemx set check type off
7693Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7694current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7695match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 7696evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
7697message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7698
7699@item set check type warn
7700Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7701evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7702be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7703numbers and structures.
7704
7705@item show type
5d161b24 7706Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7707is setting it automatically.
7708@end table
7709
7710@cindex range checking
7711@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 7712@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7713@subsection An overview of range checking
7714
7715In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7716bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7717checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7718computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7719not exceed the bounds of the array.
7720
7721For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7722@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7723always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7724warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7725
7726A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7727array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7728of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7729error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7730result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7731the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7732
474c8240 7733@smallexample
c906108c 7734@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
474c8240 7735@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
7736
7737This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7738specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7739Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7740
7741@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7742
d4f3574e 7743@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7744@kindex set check range
7745@kindex show check range
7746@table @code
7747@item set check range auto
7748Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7749@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7750each language.
7751
7752@item set check range on
7753@itemx set check range off
7754Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7755current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7756match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7757then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7758
7759@item set check range warn
7760Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7761but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7762expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7763memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7764systems).
7765
7766@item show range
7767Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7768being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7769@end table
c906108c 7770
6d2ebf8b 7771@node Support
c906108c 7772@section Supported languages
c906108c 7773
e632838e 7774@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7775@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7776Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7777language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7778and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7779,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7780language.
7781
7782The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7783supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7784tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7785@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7786formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7787books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7788language reference or tutorial.
7789
c906108c 7790@menu
b37052ae 7791* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7792* Modula-2:: Modula-2
c906108c
SS
7793@end menu
7794
6d2ebf8b 7795@node C
b37052ae 7796@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7797
b37052ae
EZ
7798@cindex C and C@t{++}
7799@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7800
b37052ae 7801Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7802to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7803together.
7804
41afff9a
EZ
7805@cindex C@t{++}
7806@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7807@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7808The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7809compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7810effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7811C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7812compiler (@code{aCC}).
7813
0179ffac
DC
7814For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7815format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7816format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7817command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7818@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7819CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
c906108c 7820
c906108c 7821@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7822* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7823* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7824* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7825* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7826* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7827* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7828* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7829@end menu
c906108c 7830
6d2ebf8b 7831@node C Operators
b37052ae 7832@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7833
b37052ae 7834@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7835
7836Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7837@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7838often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7839
b37052ae 7840For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7841
7842@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7843
c906108c 7844@item
c906108c 7845@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7846specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7847
7848@item
d4f3574e
SS
7849@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7850@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7851
7852@item
53a5351d 7853@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7854
7855@item
7856@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7857
c906108c
SS
7858@end itemize
7859
7860@noindent
7861The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7862in order of increasing precedence:
7863
7864@table @code
7865@item ,
7866The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7867are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7868expression being the last expression evaluated.
7869
7870@item =
7871Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7872assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7873
7874@item @var{op}=
7875Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7876and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7877@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7878@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7879@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7880
7881@item ?:
7882The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7883of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7884integral type.
7885
7886@item ||
7887Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7888
7889@item &&
7890Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7891
7892@item |
7893Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7894
7895@item ^
7896Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7897
7898@item &
7899Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7900
7901@item ==@r{, }!=
7902Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7903expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7904
7905@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7906Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7907Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7908and non-zero for true.
7909
7910@item <<@r{, }>>
7911left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7912
7913@item @@
7914The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7915
7916@item +@r{, }-
7917Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7918pointer types.
7919
7920@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7921Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7922defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7923integral types.
7924
7925@item ++@r{, }--
7926Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7927operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7928when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7929operation takes place.
7930
7931@item *
7932Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7933@code{++}.
7934
7935@item &
7936Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7937
b37052ae
EZ
7938For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7939allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7940(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7941where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7942stored.
c906108c
SS
7943
7944@item -
7945Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7946precedence as @code{++}.
7947
7948@item !
7949Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7950@code{++}.
7951
7952@item ~
7953Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7954@code{++}.
7955
7956
7957@item .@r{, }->
7958Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7959@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7960pointer based on the stored type information.
7961Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7962
c906108c
SS
7963@item .*@r{, }->*
7964Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7965
7966@item []
7967Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7968@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7969
7970@item ()
7971Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7972
c906108c 7973@item ::
b37052ae 7974C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7975and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7976
7977@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7978Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7979(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7980above.
c906108c
SS
7981@end table
7982
c906108c
SS
7983If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7984attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7985predefined meaning.
c906108c 7986
c906108c 7987@menu
5d161b24 7988* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7989@end menu
7990
6d2ebf8b 7991@node C Constants
b37052ae 7992@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7993
b37052ae 7994@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7995
b37052ae 7996@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7997following ways:
c906108c
SS
7998
7999@itemize @bullet
8000@item
8001Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6ca652b0
EZ
8002specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8003by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
c906108c
SS
8004@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8005@code{long} value.
8006
8007@item
8008Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8009point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8010exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8011@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8012sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
8013A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8014@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8015the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8016a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8017constant.
c906108c
SS
8018
8019@item
8020Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8021integral equivalents.
8022
8023@item
8024Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8025(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 8026(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
8027be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8028the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8029of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8030@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8031@samp{\n} for newline.
8032
8033@item
96a2c332
SS
8034String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8035double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8036above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8037a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8038characters.
c906108c
SS
8039
8040@item
8041Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8042to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8043
8044@item
8045Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8046and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8047integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8048and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8049@end itemize
8050
c906108c 8051@menu
5d161b24
DB
8052* C plus plus expressions::
8053* C Defaults::
8054* C Checks::
c906108c 8055
5d161b24 8056* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
8057@end menu
8058
6d2ebf8b 8059@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
8060@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8061
8062@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8063@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8064
0179ffac
DC
8065@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8066@cindex C@t{++} compilers
8067@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8068@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
c906108c 8069@quotation
b37052ae 8070@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
0179ffac
DC
8071proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8072works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8073@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8074@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8075stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8076stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8077specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8078are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8079C@t{++} code.
c906108c 8080@end quotation
c906108c
SS
8081
8082@enumerate
8083
8084@cindex member functions
8085@item
8086Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8087
474c8240 8088@smallexample
c906108c 8089count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
474c8240 8090@end smallexample
c906108c 8091
41afff9a 8092@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 8093@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8094@item
8095While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8096expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8097that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 8098pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 8099
c906108c 8100@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 8101@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 8102@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8103@item
8104You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 8105call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
8106perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8107calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8108in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8109default arguments.
8110
8111It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8112promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8113class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8114functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8115number of function arguments.
8116
8117Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8118@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 8119,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 8120
d4f3574e 8121You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
8122explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8123@smallexample
8124p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8125@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8126
c906108c 8127The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 8128see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 8129
c906108c
SS
8130@cindex reference declarations
8131@item
b37052ae
EZ
8132@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8133them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
8134dereferenced.
8135
8136In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8137reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8138avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8139The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8140you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8141
8142@item
b37052ae 8143@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
8144expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8145one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8146necessary, for example in an expression like
8147@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 8148resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8149debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8150@end enumerate
8151
b37052ae 8152In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
8153calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8154objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8155invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 8156
6d2ebf8b 8157@node C Defaults
b37052ae 8158@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 8159
b37052ae 8160@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 8161
c906108c
SS
8162If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8163both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 8164C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 8165selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
8166
8167If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8168recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8169@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 8170these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
8171@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8172for further details.
8173
c906108c
SS
8174@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8175@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8176@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 8177
6d2ebf8b 8178@node C Checks
b37052ae 8179@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 8180
b37052ae 8181@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 8182
b37052ae 8183By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
8184is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8185considers two variables type equivalent if:
8186
8187@itemize @bullet
8188@item
8189The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8190enumerated tag.
8191
8192@item
8193The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8194declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8195
8196@ignore
8197@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8198@c FIXME--beers?
8199@item
8200The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8201declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8202compilers.)
8203@end ignore
8204@end itemize
8205
8206Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8207indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8208that is not itself an array.
c906108c 8209
6d2ebf8b 8210@node Debugging C
c906108c 8211@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
8212
8213The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8214the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
8215inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8216appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
8217
8218The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8219with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8220,Expressions}.
8221
c906108c 8222@menu
5d161b24 8223* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
8224@end menu
8225
6d2ebf8b 8226@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 8227@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 8228
b37052ae 8229@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 8230
b37052ae
EZ
8231Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8232designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
8233
8234@table @code
8235@cindex break in overloaded functions
8236@item @r{breakpoint menus}
8237When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8238@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8239you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8240
b37052ae 8241@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
8242@item rbreak @var{regex}
8243Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8244breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8245classes.
8246@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8247
b37052ae 8248@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
8249@item catch throw
8250@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 8251Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
8252Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8253
8254@cindex inheritance
8255@item ptype @var{typename}
8256Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8257@var{typename}.
8258@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8259
b37052ae 8260@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
8261@item set print demangle
8262@itemx show print demangle
8263@itemx set print asm-demangle
8264@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
8265Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8266displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
8267@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8268
8269@item set print object
8270@itemx show print object
8271Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8272@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8273
8274@item set print vtbl
8275@itemx show print vtbl
8276Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8277@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 8278(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 8279ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
8280
8281@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 8282@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 8283@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 8284Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
8285is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8286and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 8287using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 8288expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
8289message.
8290
8291@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 8292Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
8293overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8294chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8295symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8296overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8297searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8298argument types.
c906108c
SS
8299
8300@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8301You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 8302the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
8303@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8304also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8305available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8306@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8307@end table
c906108c 8308
6d2ebf8b 8309@node Modula-2
c906108c 8310@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 8311
d4f3574e 8312@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
8313
8314The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8315output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8316developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8317attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8318to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8319table.
8320
8321@cindex expressions in Modula-2
8322@menu
8323* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8324* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8325* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8326* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8327* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8328* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8329* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8330* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8331@end menu
8332
6d2ebf8b 8333@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
8334@subsubsection Operators
8335@cindex Modula-2 operators
8336
8337Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8338@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8339often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8340following definitions hold:
8341
8342@itemize @bullet
8343
8344@item
8345@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8346their subranges.
8347
8348@item
8349@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8350
8351@item
8352@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8353
8354@item
8355@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8356@var{type}}.
8357
8358@item
8359@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8360
8361@item
8362@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8363
8364@item
8365@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8366@end itemize
8367
8368@noindent
8369The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8370increasing precedence:
8371
8372@table @code
8373@item ,
8374Function argument or array index separator.
8375
8376@item :=
8377Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8378@var{value}.
8379
8380@item <@r{, }>
8381Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8382types.
8383
8384@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 8385Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
8386on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8387set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8388
8389@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8390Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8391Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8392available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8393comment character.
8394
8395@item IN
8396Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8397Same precedence as @code{<}.
8398
8399@item OR
8400Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8401
8402@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 8403Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
8404
8405@item @@
8406The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8407
8408@item +@r{, }-
8409Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8410and difference on set types.
8411
8412@item *
8413Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8414on set types.
8415
8416@item /
8417Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8418types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8419
8420@item DIV@r{, }MOD
8421Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8422precedence as @code{*}.
8423
8424@item -
8425Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8426
8427@item ^
8428Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8429
8430@item NOT
8431Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8432@code{^}.
8433
8434@item .
8435@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8436precedence as @code{^}.
8437
8438@item []
8439Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8440
8441@item ()
8442Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8443as @code{^}.
8444
8445@item ::@r{, }.
8446@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8447@end table
8448
8449@quotation
8450@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8451treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8452@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8453@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8454@end quotation
8455
cb51c4e0 8456
6d2ebf8b 8457@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 8458@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 8459@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
8460
8461Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8462In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8463
8464@table @var
8465
8466@item a
8467represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8468
8469@item c
8470represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8471
8472@item i
8473represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8474
8475@item m
8476represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8477same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8478be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8479
8480@item n
8481represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8482
8483@item r
8484represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8485
8486@item t
8487represents a type.
8488
8489@item v
8490represents a variable.
8491
8492@item x
8493represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8494explanation of the function for details.
8495@end table
8496
8497All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8498
8499@table @code
8500@item ABS(@var{n})
8501Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8502
8503@item CAP(@var{c})
8504If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 8505equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
8506
8507@item CHR(@var{i})
8508Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8509
8510@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8511Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8512
8513@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8514Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8515new value.
8516
8517@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8518Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8519set.
8520
8521@item FLOAT(@var{i})
8522Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8523
8524@item HIGH(@var{a})
8525Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8526
8527@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 8528Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
8529
8530@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8531Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8532new value.
8533
8534@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8535Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8536there. Returns the new set.
8537
8538@item MAX(@var{t})
8539Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8540
8541@item MIN(@var{t})
8542Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8543
8544@item ODD(@var{i})
8545Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8546
8547@item ORD(@var{x})
8548Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
8549value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8550@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
8551integral, character and enumerated types.
8552
8553@item SIZE(@var{x})
8554Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8555
8556@item TRUNC(@var{r})
8557Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8558
8559@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8560Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8561@end table
8562
8563@quotation
8564@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8565@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8566an error.
8567@end quotation
8568
8569@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 8570@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
8571@subsubsection Constants
8572
8573@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8574ways:
8575
8576@itemize @bullet
8577
8578@item
8579Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8580expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8581rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8582trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8583
8584@item
8585Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8586decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8587then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8588@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8589digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8590digits.
8591
8592@item
8593Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8594like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 8595also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
8596followed by a @samp{C}.
8597
8598@item
8599String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8600pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8601Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 8602Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
8603sequences.
8604
8605@item
8606Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8607
8608@item
8609Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8610@code{FALSE}.
8611
8612@item
8613Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8614
8615@item
8616Set constants are not yet supported.
8617@end itemize
8618
6d2ebf8b 8619@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
8620@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8621@cindex Modula-2 defaults
8622
8623If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8624both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8625Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8626selected the working language.
8627
8628If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8629code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 8630working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
8631the language automatically}, for further details.
8632
6d2ebf8b 8633@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
8634@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8635@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8636
8637A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8638This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8639
8640@itemize @bullet
8641@item
8642Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8643integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8644debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8645pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8646through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8647returned a pointer.)
8648
8649@item
8650C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8651non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8652escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8653printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8654
8655@item
8656The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8657argument.
8658
8659@item
8660All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8661@end itemize
8662
6d2ebf8b 8663@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
8664@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8665@cindex Modula-2 checks
8666
8667@quotation
8668@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8669range checking.
8670@end quotation
8671@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8672
8673@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8674
8675@itemize @bullet
8676@item
8677They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8678@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8679
8680@item
8681They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8682@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8683@end itemize
8684
8685As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8686whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8687
8688Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8689index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8690
6d2ebf8b 8691@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
8692@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8693@cindex scope
41afff9a 8694@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
8695@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8696@ifinfo
41afff9a 8697@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8698@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8699@end ifinfo
8700@iftex
41afff9a 8701@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
8702@end iftex
8703
8704There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8705(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8706similar syntax:
8707
474c8240 8708@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8709
8710@var{module} . @var{id}
8711@var{scope} :: @var{id}
474c8240 8712@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8713
8714@noindent
8715where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8716@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8717identifier within your program, except another module.
8718
8719Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8720specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8721found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8722enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8723
8724Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8725the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8726definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8727an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8728module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8729@var{module}.
8730
6d2ebf8b 8731@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8732@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8733
8734Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8735Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8736specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8737@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8738apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8739analogue in Modula-2.
8740
8741The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8742with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8743intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8744created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8745address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8746@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8747
8748@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8749In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8750interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8751
6d2ebf8b 8752@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8753@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8754
d4f3574e 8755The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8756symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8757program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8758does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8759program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8760(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8761file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8762
8763@cindex symbol names
8764@cindex names of symbols
8765@cindex quoting names
8766Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8767characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8768most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8769source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8770are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8771ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8772@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8773@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8774
474c8240 8775@smallexample
c906108c 8776p 'foo.c'::x
474c8240 8777@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8778
8779@noindent
8780looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8781
8782@table @code
8783@kindex info address
b37052ae 8784@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8785@item info address @var{symbol}
8786Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8787variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8788local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8789is always stored.
8790
8791Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8792at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8793the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8794
3d67e040 8795@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8796@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8797@item info symbol @var{addr}
8798Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8799If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8800nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8801
474c8240 8802@smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8803(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8804_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
474c8240 8805@end smallexample
3d67e040
EZ
8806
8807@noindent
8808This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8809it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8810
c906108c 8811@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8812@item whatis @var{expr}
8813Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8814actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8815assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8816@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8817
8818@item whatis
8819Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8820
8821@kindex ptype
8822@item ptype @var{typename}
8823Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8824the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8825@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8826@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8827
d4f3574e 8828@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8829@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8830Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8831differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8832of just the name of the type.
8833
8834For example, for this variable declaration:
8835
474c8240 8836@smallexample
c906108c 8837struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
474c8240 8838@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8839
8840@noindent
8841the two commands give this output:
8842
474c8240 8843@smallexample
c906108c
SS
8844@group
8845(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8846type = struct complex
8847(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8848type = struct complex @{
8849 double real;
8850 double imag;
8851@}
8852@end group
474c8240 8853@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
8854
8855@noindent
8856As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8857the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8858
8859@kindex info types
8860@item info types @var{regexp}
8861@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8862Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8863(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8864complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8865@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8866names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8867information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8868
8869This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8870@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8871lists all source files where a type is defined.
8872
b37052ae
EZ
8873@kindex info scope
8874@cindex local variables
8875@item info scope @var{addr}
8876List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8877accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8878preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8879scope defined by that location. For example:
8880
8881@smallexample
8882(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8883Scope for command_line_handler:
8884Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8885Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8886Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8887Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8888Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8889Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8890Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8891@end smallexample
8892
f5c37c66
EZ
8893@noindent
8894This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8895during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8896collect}.
8897
c906108c
SS
8898@kindex info source
8899@item info source
919d772c
JB
8900Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8901the function containing the current point of execution:
8902@itemize @bullet
8903@item
8904the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8905@item
8906the directory it was compiled in,
8907@item
8908its length, in lines,
8909@item
8910which programming language it is written in,
8911@item
8912whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8913if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8914@item
8915whether the debugging information includes information about
8916preprocessor macros.
8917@end itemize
8918
c906108c
SS
8919
8920@kindex info sources
8921@item info sources
8922Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8923debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8924have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8925
8926@kindex info functions
8927@item info functions
8928Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8929
8930@item info functions @var{regexp}
8931Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8932whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8933Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8934include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8935start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8936that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8937@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8938
8939@kindex info variables
8940@item info variables
8941Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
6ca652b0 8942outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
c906108c
SS
8943
8944@item info variables @var{regexp}
8945Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8946variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8947@var{regexp}.
8948
8949@ignore
8950This was never implemented.
8951@kindex info methods
8952@item info methods
8953@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8954The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8955methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8956specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8957C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8958from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8959@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8960which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8961@end ignore
8962
c906108c
SS
8963@cindex reloading symbols
8964Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8965be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8966in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8967running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8968@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8969
8970@table @code
8971@kindex set symbol-reloading
8972@item set symbol-reloading on
8973Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8974object file with a particular name is seen again.
8975
8976@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8977Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8978same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8979running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8980should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8981may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8982several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8983name.
c906108c
SS
8984
8985@kindex show symbol-reloading
8986@item show symbol-reloading
8987Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8988@end table
c906108c 8989
c906108c
SS
8990@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8991@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8992Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8993declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8994@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8995source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8996another source file. The default is on.
8997
8998A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8999the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9000
9001@item set opaque-type-resolution off
9002Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9003is printed as follows:
9004@smallexample
9005@{<no data fields>@}
9006@end smallexample
9007
9008@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9009@item show opaque-type-resolution
9010Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
9011
9012@kindex maint print symbols
9013@cindex symbol dump
9014@kindex maint print psymbols
9015@cindex partial symbol dump
9016@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9017@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9018@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9019Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9020These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9021symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9022symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9023collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9024only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9025command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9026use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9027symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9028files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9029@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9030required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9031@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9032@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9033@end table
9034
6d2ebf8b 9035@node Altering
c906108c
SS
9036@chapter Altering Execution
9037
9038Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9039find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9040correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9041experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9042program.
9043
9044For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
9045locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9046address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
9047
9048@menu
9049* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9050* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 9051* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
9052* Returning:: Returning from a function
9053* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9054* Patching:: Patching your program
9055@end menu
9056
6d2ebf8b 9057@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
9058@section Assignment to variables
9059
9060@cindex assignment
9061@cindex setting variables
9062To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9063@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9064
474c8240 9065@smallexample
c906108c 9066print x=4
474c8240 9067@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9068
9069@noindent
9070stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 9071value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
9072@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9073information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
9074
9075@kindex set variable
9076@cindex variables, setting
9077If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9078@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9079really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9080not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9081,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9082
c906108c
SS
9083If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9084appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9085variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9086to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9087program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9088a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9089command @code{set width}:
9090
474c8240 9091@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9092(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9093type = double
9094(@value{GDBP}) p width
9095$4 = 13
9096(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9097Invalid syntax in expression.
474c8240 9098@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9099
9100@noindent
9101The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9102order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9103
474c8240 9104@smallexample
c906108c 9105(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
474c8240 9106@end smallexample
53a5351d 9107
c906108c
SS
9108Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9109with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9110@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9111your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9112to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9113the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9114
474c8240 9115@smallexample
c906108c
SS
9116@group
9117(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9118type = double
9119(@value{GDBP}) p g
9120$1 = 1
9121(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 9122(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
9123$2 = 1
9124(@value{GDBP}) r
9125The program being debugged has been started already.
9126Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9127Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
9128"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9129 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
9130(@value{GDBP}) show g
9131The current BFD target is "=4".
9132@end group
474c8240 9133@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9134
9135@noindent
9136The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9137@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9138@code{g}, use
9139
474c8240 9140@smallexample
c906108c 9141(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
474c8240 9142@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9143
9144@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9145freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9146and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9147same length or shorter.
9148@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9149@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9150
9151To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9152construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9153(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9154to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9155and representation in memory), and
9156
474c8240 9157@smallexample
c906108c 9158set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
474c8240 9159@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9160
9161@noindent
9162stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9163
6d2ebf8b 9164@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
9165@section Continuing at a different address
9166
9167Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9168it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9169an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9170
9171@table @code
9172@kindex jump
9173@item jump @var{linespec}
9174Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9175immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9176source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9177@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9178in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9179breakpoints}.
9180
9181The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9182the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9183register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9184a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9185be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9186of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9187confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9188executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9189well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9190
9191@item jump *@var{address}
9192Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9193@end table
9194
c906108c 9195@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
9196On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9197command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9198difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9199changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9200example,
c906108c 9201
474c8240 9202@smallexample
c906108c 9203set $pc = 0x485
474c8240 9204@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
9205
9206@noindent
9207makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9208address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9209@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
9210
9211The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9212up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9213that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9214detail.
9215
c906108c 9216@c @group
6d2ebf8b 9217@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
9218@section Giving your program a signal
9219
9220@table @code
9221@kindex signal
9222@item signal @var{signal}
9223Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9224signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9225signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9226SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9227
9228Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9229giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9230a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9231@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9232signal.
9233
9234@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9235after executing the command.
9236@end table
9237@c @end group
9238
9239Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9240@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9241causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9242the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9243passes the signal directly to your program.
9244
c906108c 9245
6d2ebf8b 9246@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9247@section Returning from a function
9248
9249@table @code
9250@cindex returning from a function
9251@kindex return
9252@item return
9253@itemx return @var{expression}
9254You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9255command. If you give an
9256@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9257value.
9258@end table
9259
9260When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9261(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9262discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9263be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9264
9265This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9266frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9267innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9268specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9269of functions.
9270
9271The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9272program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9273returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9274and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9275selected stack frame returns naturally.
9276
6d2ebf8b 9277@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9278@section Calling program functions
9279
9280@cindex calling functions
9281@kindex call
9282@table @code
9283@item call @var{expr}
9284Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9285returned values.
9286@end table
9287
9288You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9289execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9290with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9291is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9292
6d2ebf8b 9293@node Patching
c906108c 9294@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9295
c906108c
SS
9296@cindex patching binaries
9297@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9298@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9299
7a292a7a
SS
9300By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9301executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9302alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9303patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9304
9305If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9306explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9307want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9308repairs.
9309
9310@table @code
9311@kindex set write
9312@item set write on
9313@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9314If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9315core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9316off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9317
9318If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9319@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9320write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9321
9322@item show write
9323@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9324Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9325as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9326@end table
9327
6d2ebf8b 9328@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9329@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9330
7a292a7a
SS
9331@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9332both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9333program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9334@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9335
9336@menu
9337* Files:: Commands to specify files
5b5d99cf 9338* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
c906108c
SS
9339* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9340@end menu
9341
6d2ebf8b 9342@node Files
c906108c 9343@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9344
7a292a7a 9345@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9346@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9347
9348You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9349way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9350@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9351Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9352
9353Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9354@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9355a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9356to specify new files are useful.
9357
9358@table @code
9359@cindex executable file
9360@kindex file
9361@item file @var{filename}
9362Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9363symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9364executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9365directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9366@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9367directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9368to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9369and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9370
6d2ebf8b 9371On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9372@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9373@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9374@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9375descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9376(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9377@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9378for more information.
c906108c
SS
9379
9380@item file
9381@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9382has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9383
9384@kindex exec-file
9385@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9386Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9387in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9388if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9389discard information on the executable file.
9390
9391@kindex symbol-file
9392@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9393Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9394searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9395table and program to run from the same file.
9396
9397@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9398program's symbol table.
9399
5d161b24 9400The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9401of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9402auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9403the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9404the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9405
9406@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9407executing it once.
9408
9409When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9410understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9411generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9412other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9413Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9414using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9415optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9416
9417For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9418using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9419symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9420quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9421details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9422
9423The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9424start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9425occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9426file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9427pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9428warnings and messages}.)
9429
c906108c
SS
9430We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9431symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9432symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9433still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9434in stabs format.
9435
9436@kindex readnow
9437@cindex reading symbols immediately
9438@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9439@kindex mapped
9440@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9441@cindex saving symbol table
9442@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9443@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9444You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9445tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9446load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9447entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9448
c906108c
SS
9449If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9450@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9451cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9452file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9453from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9454than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9455program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9456starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9457
9458You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9459file has all the symbol information for your program.
9460
9461The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9462@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9463than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9464it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9465needed.
9466
9467The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9468@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9469symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9470
9471@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9472@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9473@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9474@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9475@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9476@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9477@c files.
9478
9479@kindex core
9480@kindex core-file
9481@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9482Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9483of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9484address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9485executable file itself for other parts.
9486
9487@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9488to be used.
9489
9490Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9491under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9492wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9493the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9494(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9495
c906108c
SS
9496@kindex add-symbol-file
9497@cindex dynamic linking
9498@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9499@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9500@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9501The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9502information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9503when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9504into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9505address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9506this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9507of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9508section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9509@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9510
9511The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9512originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9513@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9514thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9515instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9516
17d9d558
JB
9517@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9518@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9519@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9520@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9521@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9522Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9523executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9524relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9525information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9526
9527@itemize @bullet
9528@item
9529the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9530that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9531@item
9532every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9533been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9534@item
9535you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9536provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9537@end itemize
9538
9539@noindent
9540Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9541relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9542typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9543important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9544procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9545assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9546general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9547relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9548as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9549way.
9550
c906108c
SS
9551@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9552
9553You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9554the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9555table information for @var{filename}.
9556
9557@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9558@item add-shared-symbol-file
9559The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9560operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9561shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9562@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9563
c906108c
SS
9564@kindex section
9565@item section
5d161b24
DB
9566The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9567the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9568section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9569specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9570separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9571the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9572
9573@kindex info files
9574@kindex info target
9575@item info files
9576@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9577@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9578current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9579including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9580use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9581command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9582current ones.
9583
fe95c787
MS
9584@kindex maint info sections
9585@item maint info sections
9586Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9587is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9588displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9589offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9590@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9591may be arbitrarily combined):
9592
9593@table @code
9594@item ALLOBJ
9595Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9596@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9597Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9598@item @var{section-flags}
9599Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9600The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9601@table @code
9602@item ALLOC
9603Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9604Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9605@item LOAD
9606Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9607Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9608@item RELOC
9609Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9610@item READONLY
9611Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9612@item CODE
9613Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9614@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9615Section contains data only (no executable code).
9616@item ROM
9617Section will reside in ROM.
9618@item CONSTRUCTOR
9619Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9620@item HAS_CONTENTS
9621Section is not empty.
9622@item NEVER_LOAD
9623An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9624@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9625A notification to the linker that the section contains
9626COFF shared library information.
9627@item IS_COMMON
9628Section contains common symbols.
9629@end table
9630@end table
6763aef9
MS
9631@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9632@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9633Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
6ca652b0 9634really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
6763aef9
MS
9635In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9636out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9637For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9638enhancement to debugging performance.
9639
9640The default is off.
9641
9642@item set trust-readonly-sections off
15110bc3 9643Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
6763aef9
MS
9644the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9645and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9646@end table
9647
9648All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9649as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9650name and remembers it that way.
9651
c906108c 9652@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9653@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9654libraries.
53a5351d 9655
c906108c
SS
9656@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9657when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9658(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9659references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9660debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9661
9662On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9663automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9664
c906108c
SS
9665@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9666@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9667@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9668
b7209cb4
FF
9669There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9670symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9671particularly large or there are many of them.
9672
9673To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9674commands:
9675
9676@table @code
9677@kindex set auto-solib-add
9678@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9679If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9680will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9681attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9682informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9683is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9684@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9685
9686@kindex show auto-solib-add
9687@item show auto-solib-add
9688Display the current autoloading mode.
9689@end table
9690
9691To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9692command:
9693
c906108c
SS
9694@table @code
9695@kindex info sharedlibrary
9696@kindex info share
9697@item info share
9698@itemx info sharedlibrary
9699Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9700
9701@kindex sharedlibrary
9702@kindex share
9703@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9704@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9705Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9706Unix regular expression.
9707As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9708required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9709@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9710loaded.
9711@end table
9712
b7209cb4
FF
9713On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9714autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9715reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9716by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9717up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9718wish.
c906108c
SS
9719
9720Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9721loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9722@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9723automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9724
9725To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9726
9727@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9728@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9729@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9730Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9731If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9732symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9733size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9734Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
6ca652b0 9735@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
b7209cb4 9736Mb).
c906108c 9737
b7209cb4
FF
9738@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9739@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9740Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9741@end table
c906108c 9742
f5ebfba0
DJ
9743Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
9744configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
9745host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
9746copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
9747not.
9748
9749You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
9750load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
9751@value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
9752libraries.
9753
9754@table @code
9755@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
9756@item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
9757If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
9758absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
9759paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
9760@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
9761out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
9762@file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
9763
9764You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
9765configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
9766
9767@kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
9768@item show solib-absolute-prefix
9769Display the current shared library prefix.
9770
9771@kindex set solib-search-path
9772@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
9773If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
9774to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
9775@samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
9776the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
9777@samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
9778set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
9779@value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
9780
9781@kindex show solib-search-path
9782@item show solib-search-path
9783Display the current shared library search path.
9784@end table
9785
5b5d99cf
JB
9786
9787@node Separate Debug Files
9788@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
9789@cindex separate debugging information files
9790@cindex debugging information in separate files
9791@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
9792@cindex debugging information directory, global
9793@cindex global debugging information directory
9794
9795@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
9796file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
9797@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
9798Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
9799than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
9800information for their executables in separate files, which users can
9801install only when they need to debug a problem.
9802
9803If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
9804separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
9805the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
9806components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
9807debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
9808containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
9809debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
9810will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
9811places:
9812
9813@itemize @bullet
9814@item
9815the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
9816for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
9817@item
9818a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
9819file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
9820@item
9821a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
9822executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
9823@file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
9824@var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
9825@var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
9826@end itemize
9827@noindent
9828@value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
9829information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
9830reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
9831
9832So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
9833which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
9834debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
9835for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
9836@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
9837@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
9838
9839You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
9840name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
9841
9842@table @code
9843
9844@kindex set debug-file-directory
9845@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
9846Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9847information files to @var{directory}.
9848
9849@kindex show debug-file-directory
9850@item show debug-file-directory
9851Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9852information files.
9853
9854@end table
9855
9856@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
9857@cindex debug links
9858A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
9859@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
9860
9861@itemize
9862@item
9863A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
9864a zero byte,
9865@item
9866zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
9867boundary within the section, and
9868@item
9869a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
9870executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
9871information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
9872zero as the @var{crc} argument.
9873@end itemize
9874
9875Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
9876contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
9877described above.
9878
9879The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
9880executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
9881debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
9882should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
9883but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
9884in an ordinary executable.
9885
9886As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
9887separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
9888Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
9889contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
9890@kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
9891the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
9892@file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
9893
9894Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
9895polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
9896describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
9897complete code for a function that computes it:
9898
9899@kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
9900@smallexample
9901unsigned long
9902gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
9903 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
9904@{
9905 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
9906 @{
9907 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
9908 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
9909 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
9910 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
9911 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
9912 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
9913 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
9914 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
9915 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
9916 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
9917 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
9918 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
9919 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
9920 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
9921 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
9922 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
9923 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
9924 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
9925 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
9926 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
9927 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
9928 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
9929 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
9930 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
9931 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
9932 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
9933 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
9934 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
9935 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
9936 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
9937 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
9938 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
9939 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
9940 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
9941 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
9942 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
9943 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
9944 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
9945 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
9946 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
9947 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
9948 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
9949 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
9950 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
9951 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
9952 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
9953 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
9954 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
9955 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
9956 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
9957 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
9958 0x2d02ef8d
9959 @};
9960 unsigned char *end;
9961
9962 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
9963 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
9964 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
9965 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;;
9966@}
9967@end smallexample
9968
9969
6d2ebf8b 9970@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9971@section Errors reading symbol files
9972
9973While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9974such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9975output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9976they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9977debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9978about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9979only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9980times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9981to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9982complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9983messages}).
9984
9985The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9986
9987@table @code
9988@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9989
9990The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9991(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9992error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9993in its outer scope blocks.
9994
9995@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9996the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9997may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9998function.
9999
10000@item block at @var{address} out of order
10001
10002The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10003order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10004do so.
10005
10006@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10007locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10008can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10009@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10010messages}.)
10011
10012@item bad block start address patched
10013
10014The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10015smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10016to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10017
10018@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10019starting on the previous source line.
10020
10021@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10022
10023@cindex foo
10024Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10025larger than the size of the string table.
10026
10027@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10028name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10029with this name.
10030
10031@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10032
7a292a7a
SS
10033The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10034not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 10035uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 10036
7a292a7a
SS
10037@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10038This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 10039are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
10040debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10041on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10042and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
10043
10044@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 10045
7a292a7a 10046@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 10047
7a292a7a 10048@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 10049The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
10050information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10051it.
c906108c
SS
10052
10053@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10054
10055@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 10056
c906108c
SS
10057@end table
10058
6d2ebf8b 10059@node Targets
c906108c 10060@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 10061
c906108c
SS
10062@cindex debugging target
10063@kindex target
10064
10065A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
10066
10067Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10068in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10069you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
10070flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10071host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
10072realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10073command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10074(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
10075
10076@menu
10077* Active Targets:: Active targets
10078* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
10079* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10080* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 10081* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
10082
10083@end menu
10084
6d2ebf8b 10085@node Active Targets
c906108c 10086@section Active targets
7a292a7a 10087
c906108c
SS
10088@cindex stacking targets
10089@cindex active targets
10090@cindex multiple targets
10091
c906108c 10092There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
10093executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10094active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10095start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10096a core file.
c906108c
SS
10097
10098For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10099@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10100well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10101@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10102first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10103requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10104are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10105read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10106executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
10107
10108When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
10109target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10110commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10111an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10112process target is active.
c906108c 10113
7a292a7a
SS
10114Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10115core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 10116files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
10117the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10118process}).
c906108c 10119
6d2ebf8b 10120@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
10121@section Commands for managing targets
10122
10123@table @code
10124@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
10125Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10126process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10127facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10128protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
10129
10130Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10131typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10132with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
10133
10134The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10135after executing the command.
10136
10137@kindex help target
10138@item help target
10139Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10140currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10141(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10142
10143@item help target @var{name}
10144Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10145select it.
10146
10147@kindex set gnutarget
10148@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 10149@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 10150knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
10151a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10152with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
10153with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10154
d4f3574e 10155@quotation
c906108c
SS
10156@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10157you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 10158@end quotation
c906108c 10159
d4f3574e
SS
10160@noindent
10161@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 10162
5d161b24 10163@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
10164@item show gnutarget
10165Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10166@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10167@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10168and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10169@end table
10170
c906108c
SS
10171Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10172configuration):
c906108c
SS
10173
10174@table @code
10175@kindex target exec
10176@item target exec @var{program}
10177An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10178@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10179
c906108c
SS
10180@kindex target core
10181@item target core @var{filename}
10182A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10183@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
10184
10185@kindex target remote
10186@item target remote @var{dev}
10187Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10188specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10189@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10190supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
10191some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10192it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10193
c906108c
SS
10194@kindex target sim
10195@item target sim
2df3850c 10196Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213 10197In general,
474c8240 10198@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10199 target sim
10200 load
10201 run
474c8240 10202@end smallexample
d4f3574e 10203@noindent
104c1213 10204works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 10205drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
10206provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10207see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10208Processors}.
10209
c906108c
SS
10210@end table
10211
104c1213 10212Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
10213
10214@table @code
10215
c906108c
SS
10216@kindex target nrom
10217@item target nrom @var{dev}
10218NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10219
c906108c
SS
10220@end table
10221
5d161b24 10222Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 10223your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
10224
10225Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10226once you've successfully established a connection.
10227
10228@table @code
10229
10230@kindex load @var{filename}
10231@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
10232Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10233@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10234is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10235on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10236@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10237the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10238
10239If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10240execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10241target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
10242
10243The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10244For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10245link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10246specifies a fixed address.
10247@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10248
c906108c
SS
10249@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10250@end table
10251
6d2ebf8b 10252@node Byte Order
c906108c 10253@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 10254
c906108c
SS
10255@cindex choosing target byte order
10256@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
10257
10258Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10259offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10260orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10261designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10262which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 10263@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
10264
10265@table @code
10266@kindex set endian big
10267@item set endian big
10268Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10269
10270@kindex set endian little
10271@item set endian little
10272Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10273
10274@kindex set endian auto
10275@item set endian auto
10276Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10277executable.
10278
10279@item show endian
10280Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10281
10282@end table
10283
10284Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10285data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10286target system.
10287
6d2ebf8b 10288@node Remote
c906108c
SS
10289@section Remote debugging
10290@cindex remote debugging
10291
10292If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
10293@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10294For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
10295or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10296powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10297
10298Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10299to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 10300@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
10301but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10302write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10303communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10304
10305Other remote targets may be available in your
10306configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 10307
6f05cf9f
AC
10308@node KOD
10309@section Kernel Object Display
10310
10311@cindex kernel object display
10312@cindex kernel object
10313@cindex KOD
10314
10315Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10316@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10317and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10318mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10319displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10320
10321Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10322@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10323
474c8240 10324@smallexample
6f05cf9f 10325(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
474c8240 10326@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10327
10328If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10329about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10330which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10331after the operating system:
c906108c 10332
474c8240 10333@smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10334(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10335List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10336Object Description
10337any Any and all objects
474c8240 10338@end smallexample
6f05cf9f
AC
10339
10340Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10341by the kernel.
10342
10343There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10344is supported other than to try it.
10345
10346
10347@node Remote Debugging
10348@chapter Debugging remote programs
10349
6b2f586d
AC
10350@menu
10351* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10352* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10353* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
10354@end menu
10355
6f05cf9f
AC
10356@node Server
10357@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10358
10359@kindex gdbserver
10360@cindex remote connection without stubs
10361@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10362allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10363@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10364
10365@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10366because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10367that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10368@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10369@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10370because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10371also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10372started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10373Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10374the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10375do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10376by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10377choice for debugging.
10378
10379@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10380or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10381protocol.
10382
10383@table @emph
10384@item On the target machine,
10385you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10386@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10387strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10388system does all the symbol handling.
10389
10390To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
56460a61 10391the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
6f05cf9f
AC
10392syntax is:
10393
10394@smallexample
10395target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10396@end smallexample
10397
10398@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10399hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10400@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10401@file{/dev/com1}:
10402
10403@smallexample
10404target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10405@end smallexample
10406
10407@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10408with it.
10409
10410To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10411
10412@smallexample
10413target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10414@end smallexample
10415
10416The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10417specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10418TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10419expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10420(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10421you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10422TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10423reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10424conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10425and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10426@code{target remote} command.
10427
56460a61
DJ
10428On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10429This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10430
10431@smallexample
10432target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10433@end smallexample
10434
10435@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10436to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10437
6f05cf9f
AC
10438@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10439you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10440symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10441using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10442(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10443running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10444remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10445is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10446@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10447@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10448
10449@smallexample
10450(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10451@end smallexample
10452
10453@noindent
10454communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10455
10456@smallexample
10457(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10458@end smallexample
10459
10460@noindent
10461communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10462For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10463the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10464text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10465@samp{Connection refused}.
10466@end table
10467
10468@node NetWare
10469@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10470
10471@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10472@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10473allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10474@code{target remote}.
10475
10476@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10477using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10478
10479@table @emph
10480@item On the target machine,
10481you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10482@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10483can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10484host system does all the symbol handling.
10485
10486To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10487@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10488program. The syntax is:
10489
10490@smallexample
10491load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10492 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10493@end smallexample
10494
10495@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10496the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10497to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10498
10499For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10500communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10501using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10502
10503@smallexample
10504load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10505@end smallexample
10506
10507@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10508you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10509symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10510using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10511(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10512running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10513remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10514argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10515@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10516
10517@smallexample
10518(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10519@end smallexample
10520
10521@noindent
10522communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10523@end table
10524
10525@node remote stub
10526@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10527
8e04817f
AC
10528@cindex debugging stub, example
10529@cindex remote stub, example
10530@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10531The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10532communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10533@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10534these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10535implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10536with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10537organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10538
104c1213
JM
10539@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10540To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10541@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10542prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10543program, you need:
c906108c 10544
104c1213
JM
10545@enumerate
10546@item
10547A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10548have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10549your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10550
5d161b24 10551@item
d4f3574e 10552A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10553subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10554
104c1213
JM
10555@item
10556A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10557download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10558manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10559documentation.
10560@end enumerate
96baa820 10561
104c1213
JM
10562The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10563communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10564machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10565
104c1213
JM
10566@table @emph
10567@item On the host,
10568@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10569else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10570(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10571
10572@item On the target,
10573you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10574implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10575subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10576
10577On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10578@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10579@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10580@end table
96baa820 10581
104c1213
JM
10582The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10583machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10584@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10585
104c1213
JM
10586@cindex remote serial stub list
10587These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10588
104c1213
JM
10589@table @code
10590
10591@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10592@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10593@cindex Intel
10594@cindex i386
10595For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10596
10597@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10598@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10599@cindex Motorola 680x0
10600@cindex m680x0
10601For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10602
10603@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10604@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10605@cindex Hitachi
10606@cindex SH
10607For Hitachi SH architectures.
10608
10609@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10610@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10611@cindex Sparc
10612For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10613
10614@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10615@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10616@cindex Fujitsu
10617@cindex SparcLite
10618For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10619
10620@end table
10621
10622The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10623recently added stubs.
10624
10625@menu
10626* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10627* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10628* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10629@end menu
10630
6d2ebf8b 10631@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10632@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10633
10634@cindex remote serial stub
10635The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10636subroutines:
10637
10638@table @code
10639@item set_debug_traps
10640@kindex set_debug_traps
10641@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10642This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10643program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10644beginning of your program.
10645
10646@item handle_exception
10647@kindex handle_exception
10648@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10649This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10650explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10651run when a trap is triggered.
10652
10653@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10654execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10655with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10656protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10657representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10658information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10659retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10660execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10661@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10662machine.
104c1213
JM
10663
10664@item breakpoint
10665@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10666Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10667breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10668way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10669machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10670pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10671@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10672simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10673again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10674your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10675@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10676
10677Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10678to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10679start of your debugging session.
10680@end table
10681
6d2ebf8b 10682@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10683@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10684
10685@cindex remote stub, support routines
10686The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10687chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10688debugging target machine.
10689
10690First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10691serial port.
10692
10693@table @code
10694@item int getDebugChar()
10695@kindex getDebugChar
10696Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10697It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10698different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10699
10700@item void putDebugChar(int)
10701@kindex putDebugChar
10702Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10703It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10704different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10705@end table
10706
10707@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10708@cindex interrupting remote targets
10709If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10710running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10711for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10712character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10713remote system to stop.
10714
10715Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10716probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10717is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10718@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10719
10720Other routines you need to supply are:
10721
10722@table @code
10723@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10724@kindex exceptionHandler
10725Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10726handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10727way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10728are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10729containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10730@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10731its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10732might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10733exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10734@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10735and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10736you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10737should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10738
10739For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10740gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10741should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10742@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10743help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10744
10745@item void flush_i_cache()
10746@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10747On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10748instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10749instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10750
10751On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10752function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10753@end table
10754
10755@noindent
10756You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10757
10758@table @code
10759@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10760@kindex memset
10761This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10762memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10763@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10764either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10765@end table
10766
10767If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10768library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10769but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10770subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10771
10772
6d2ebf8b 10773@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10774@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10775
10776@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10777In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10778steps.
10779
10780@enumerate
10781@item
6d2ebf8b 10782Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10783(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10784@display
10785@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10786@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10787@end display
10788
10789@item
10790Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10791
474c8240 10792@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10793set_debug_traps();
10794breakpoint();
474c8240 10795@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10796
10797@item
10798For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10799@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10800
474c8240 10801@smallexample
104c1213 10802void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
474c8240 10803@end smallexample
104c1213 10804
d4f3574e 10805@noindent
104c1213 10806but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10807function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10808@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10809error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10810one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10811
10812@item
10813Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10814your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10815
10816@item
10817Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10818the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10819
10820@item
10821@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10822@c document that. FIXME.
10823Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10824whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10825
10826@item
10827To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10828as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10829This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10830of its pure text.
10831
d4f3574e 10832@item
104c1213 10833@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10834Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10835Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10836machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9db8d71f 10837TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
104c1213
JM
10838to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10839device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10840
474c8240 10841@smallexample
104c1213 10842target remote /dev/ttyb
474c8240 10843@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10844
10845@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10846To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9db8d71f
DJ
10847@code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10848For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
104c1213
JM
10849terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10850
474c8240 10851@smallexample
104c1213 10852target remote manyfarms:2828
474c8240 10853@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10854
10855If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10856your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10857the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10858to port 1234 on your local machine:
10859
474c8240 10860@smallexample
a2bea4c3 10861target remote :1234
474c8240 10862@end smallexample
a2bea4c3
CV
10863@noindent
10864
10865Note that the colon is still required here.
9db8d71f
DJ
10866
10867@cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10868To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10869@code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10870on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10871
10872@smallexample
10873target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10874@end smallexample
10875
10876When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10877that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10878busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10879session.
10880
104c1213
JM
10881@end enumerate
10882
10883Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10884step and continue the remote program.
10885
10886To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10887command.
10888
10889@cindex interrupting remote programs
10890@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10891Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10892interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10893program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10894and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10895interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10896
474c8240 10897@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10898Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10899Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
474c8240 10900@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
10901
10902If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10903(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10904remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10905goes back to waiting.
10906
104c1213 10907
8e04817f
AC
10908@node Configurations
10909@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10910
8e04817f
AC
10911While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10912cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10913describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10914
8e04817f
AC
10915There are three major categories of configurations: native
10916configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10917operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10918different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10919are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10920
8e04817f
AC
10921@menu
10922* Native::
10923* Embedded OS::
10924* Embedded Processors::
10925* Architectures::
10926@end menu
104c1213 10927
8e04817f
AC
10928@node Native
10929@section Native
104c1213 10930
8e04817f
AC
10931This section describes details specific to particular native
10932configurations.
6cf7e474 10933
8e04817f
AC
10934@menu
10935* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10936* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10937* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
78c47bea 10938* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
8e04817f 10939@end menu
6cf7e474 10940
8e04817f
AC
10941@node HP-UX
10942@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10943
8e04817f
AC
10944On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10945begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10946name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10947
8e04817f
AC
10948@node SVR4 Process Information
10949@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10950
8e04817f
AC
10951@kindex /proc
10952@cindex process image
104c1213 10953
8e04817f
AC
10954Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10955used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10956subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10957this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10958several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10959@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10960@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
1104b9e7 10961and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
104c1213 10962
8e04817f
AC
10963@table @code
10964@kindex info proc
10965@item info proc
10966Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10967
8e04817f
AC
10968@kindex info proc mappings
10969@item info proc mappings
10970Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10971on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10972@ignore
10973@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10974@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10975@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10976@kindex info proc times
10977@item info proc times
10978Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10979its children.
6cf7e474 10980
8e04817f
AC
10981@kindex info proc id
10982@item info proc id
10983Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10984the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10985
8e04817f
AC
10986@kindex info proc status
10987@item info proc status
10988General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10989stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10990received.
d4f3574e 10991
8e04817f
AC
10992@item info proc all
10993Show all the above information about the process.
10994@end ignore
10995@end table
104c1213 10996
8e04817f
AC
10997@node DJGPP Native
10998@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10999@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11000@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11001@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 11002
8e04817f
AC
11003@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11004MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11005that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11006top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 11007
8e04817f
AC
11008@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11009defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11010subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 11011
8e04817f
AC
11012@table @code
11013@kindex info dos
11014@item info dos
11015This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11016information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 11017
8e04817f
AC
11018@kindex sysinfo
11019@cindex MS-DOS system info
11020@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11021@item info dos sysinfo
11022This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11023platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11024DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 11025
8e04817f
AC
11026@cindex GDT
11027@cindex LDT
11028@cindex IDT
11029@cindex segment descriptor tables
11030@cindex descriptor tables display
11031@item info dos gdt
11032@itemx info dos ldt
11033@itemx info dos idt
11034These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11035and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11036tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11037that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11038descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11039descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11040rights.
104c1213 11041
8e04817f
AC
11042A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11043segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11044allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11045conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11046additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 11047
8e04817f
AC
11048@cindex garbled pointers
11049These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11050Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11051displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11052display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11053example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11054debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 11055
8e04817f
AC
11056@smallexample
11057@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11058@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11059@end smallexample
104c1213 11060
8e04817f
AC
11061@noindent
11062This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11063the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 11064
8e04817f
AC
11065@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11066@item info dos pde
11067@itemx info dos pte
11068These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11069Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11070data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11071into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11072page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11073may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11074Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11075that is currently in use.
104c1213 11076
8e04817f
AC
11077Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11078Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11079the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11080@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11081Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11082means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11083the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 11084
8e04817f
AC
11085@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11086These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11087Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11088controller.
104c1213 11089
8e04817f 11090These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 11091
8e04817f
AC
11092@cindex physical address from linear address
11093@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11094This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11095address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11096appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11097accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11098example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11099the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 11100
8e04817f
AC
11101@smallexample
11102@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11103@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11104@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11105@end smallexample
104c1213 11106
8e04817f
AC
11107@noindent
11108This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11109whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11110attributes of that page.
104c1213 11111
8e04817f
AC
11112Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11113since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11114address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11115be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11116declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11117@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 11118
8e04817f
AC
11119Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11120transfer buffer:
104c1213 11121
8e04817f
AC
11122@smallexample
11123@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11124@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11125@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11126@end smallexample
104c1213 11127
8e04817f
AC
11128@noindent
11129(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
111303rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11131this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11132mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 11133
8e04817f
AC
11134This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11135@end table
104c1213 11136
78c47bea
PM
11137@node Cygwin Native
11138@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11139@cindex MS Windows debugging
11140@cindex native Cygwin debugging
11141@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11142
11143@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
11144defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
11145subsection describes those commands.
11146
11147@table @code
11148@kindex info w32
11149@item info w32
11150This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11151information about the target system and important OS structures.
11152
11153@item info w32 selector
11154This command displays information returned by
11155the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11156It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11157a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11158Without argument, this command displays information
11159about the the six segment registers.
11160
11161@kindex info dll
11162@item info dll
11163This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11164
11165@kindex dll-symbols
11166@item dll-symbols
11167This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11168add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11169
11170@kindex set new-console
11171@item set new-console @var{mode}
11172If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11173be started in a new console on next start.
11174If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11175be started in the same console as the debugger.
11176
11177@kindex show new-console
11178@item show new-console
11179Displays whether a new console is used
11180when the debuggee is started.
11181
11182@kindex set new-group
11183@item set new-group @var{mode}
11184This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11185start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11186This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11187Ctrl-C.
11188
11189@kindex show new-group
11190@item show new-group
11191Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11192
11193@kindex set debugevents
11194@item set debugevents
11195This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11196
11197@kindex set debugexec
11198@item set debugexec
11199This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11200seen by the debugger.
11201
11202@kindex set debugexceptions
11203@item set debugexceptions
11204This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11205seen by the debugger.
11206
11207@kindex set debugmemory
11208@item set debugmemory
11209This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11210seen by the debugger.
11211
11212@kindex set shell
11213@item set shell
11214This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11215via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11216
11217@kindex show shell
11218@item show shell
11219Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11220
11221@end table
11222
8e04817f
AC
11223@node Embedded OS
11224@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 11225
8e04817f
AC
11226This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11227embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11228architectures.
d4f3574e 11229
8e04817f
AC
11230@menu
11231* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11232@end menu
104c1213 11233
8e04817f
AC
11234@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11235various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 11236
8e04817f
AC
11237@node VxWorks
11238@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 11239
8e04817f 11240@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 11241
8e04817f 11242@table @code
104c1213 11243
8e04817f
AC
11244@kindex target vxworks
11245@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11246A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11247is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 11248
8e04817f 11249@end table
104c1213 11250
8e04817f
AC
11251On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11252current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 11253
8e04817f
AC
11254@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11255VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11256the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11257both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11258@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11259installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11260@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 11261
8e04817f
AC
11262@table @code
11263@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11264@kindex vxworks-timeout
11265All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11266This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11267seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11268your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11269of a thin network line.
11270@end table
104c1213 11271
8e04817f
AC
11272The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11273this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11274procedures.
104c1213 11275
8e04817f
AC
11276@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11277To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11278to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11279library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11280VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11281kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11282source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11283information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11284manual.
11285@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 11286
8e04817f
AC
11287Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11288your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11289run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11290@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11291
8e04817f 11292@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 11293
474c8240 11294@smallexample
8e04817f 11295(vxgdb)
474c8240 11296@end smallexample
104c1213 11297
8e04817f
AC
11298@menu
11299* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11300* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11301* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11302@end menu
104c1213 11303
8e04817f
AC
11304@node VxWorks Connection
11305@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 11306
8e04817f
AC
11307The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11308network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 11309
474c8240 11310@smallexample
8e04817f 11311(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
474c8240 11312@end smallexample
104c1213 11313
8e04817f
AC
11314@need 750
11315@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11316
8e04817f
AC
11317@smallexample
11318Attaching remote machine across net...
11319Connected to tt.
11320@end smallexample
104c1213 11321
8e04817f
AC
11322@need 1000
11323@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11324loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11325these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11326path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11327to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 11328
474c8240 11329@smallexample
8e04817f 11330prog.o: No such file or directory.
474c8240 11331@end smallexample
104c1213 11332
8e04817f
AC
11333When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11334the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11335command again.
104c1213 11336
8e04817f
AC
11337@node VxWorks Download
11338@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 11339
8e04817f
AC
11340@cindex download to VxWorks
11341If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11342object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11343@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11344incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11345command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11346to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11347table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11348the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11349filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11350Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11351to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11352the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11353@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11354and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11355program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 11356
474c8240 11357@smallexample
8e04817f 11358-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
474c8240 11359@end smallexample
104c1213 11360
8e04817f
AC
11361@noindent
11362Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11363
474c8240 11364@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11365(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11366(vxgdb) load prog.o
474c8240 11367@end smallexample
104c1213 11368
8e04817f 11369@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 11370
8e04817f
AC
11371@smallexample
11372Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11373@end smallexample
104c1213 11374
8e04817f
AC
11375You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11376after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11377this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11378auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11379history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11380debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11381table.)
104c1213 11382
8e04817f
AC
11383@node VxWorks Attach
11384@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
11385
11386@cindex running VxWorks tasks
11387You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11388follows:
11389
474c8240 11390@smallexample
104c1213 11391(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
474c8240 11392@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
11393
11394@noindent
11395where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11396or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11397the time of attachment.
11398
6d2ebf8b 11399@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
11400@section Embedded Processors
11401
11402This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11403configurations.
11404
7d86b5d5 11405
104c1213 11406@menu
104c1213
JM
11407* ARM:: ARM
11408* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11409* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
104c1213
JM
11410* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11411* M68K:: Motorola M68K
104c1213 11412* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
a37295f9 11413* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
104c1213
JM
11414* PA:: HP PA Embedded
11415* PowerPC: PowerPC
11416* SH:: Hitachi SH
11417* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11418* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11419* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11420* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11421@end menu
11422
6d2ebf8b 11423@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11424@subsection ARM
11425
11426@table @code
11427
8e04817f
AC
11428@kindex target rdi
11429@item target rdi @var{dev}
11430ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11431use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11432monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11433
11434@kindex target rdp
11435@item target rdp @var{dev}
11436ARM Demon monitor.
11437
11438@end table
11439
11440@node H8/300
11441@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11442
11443@table @code
11444
11445@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11446@item target hms @var{dev}
11447A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11448Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11449line and the communications speed used.
11450
11451@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11452@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11453E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11454
11455@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11456@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11457@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11458@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11459Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11460
11461@end table
11462
11463@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11464@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11465@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11466@cindex Hitachi SH download
11467When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11468board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11469board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11470@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11471
11472@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11473Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11474
11475@enumerate
11476@item
11477that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11478for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11479emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11480the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11481H8/300, or H8/500.)
11482
11483@item
11484what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11485serial device available on your host is the default).
11486
11487@item
11488what speed to use over the serial device.
11489@end enumerate
11490
11491@menu
11492* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11493* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11494* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11495@end menu
11496
11497@node Hitachi Boards
11498@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11499
11500@c only for Unix hosts
11501@kindex device
11502@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11503Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11504need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11505first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11506hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11507
11508@kindex speed
11509@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11510@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11511speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11512hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11513the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11514@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11515
11516The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11517use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11518use a DOS host,
11519@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11520called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11521through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11522to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11523
11524The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11525program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11526sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11527the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11528
11529First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11530board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11531port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11532When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11533debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11534for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11535@code{COM2}.
11536
474c8240 11537@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11538C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11539C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11540
11541Resident portion of MODE loaded
11542
11543COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11544
474c8240 11545@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11546
11547@quotation
11548@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11549@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11550disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11551your development board.
11552@end quotation
11553
11554@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11555Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11556connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11557the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11558you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11559commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11560cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11561download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11562the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11563(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11564executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11565@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11566itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11567
11568@smallexample
11569(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11570@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11571 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11572 the conditions.
11573There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11574for details.
11575@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11576(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11577Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11578(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11579.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11580.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11581.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11582@end smallexample
11583
11584At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11585you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11586sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11587@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11588resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11589@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11590
11591Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11592available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11593you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11594
11595Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11596@itemize @bullet
11597@item
11598to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11599no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11600
11601@item
11602to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11603normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11604to detect program completion.
11605@end itemize
11606
11607In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11608development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11609
11610@node Hitachi ICE
11611@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11612
11613@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11614You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11615Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11616e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11617
11618@table @code
11619@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11620Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11621@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11622@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11623(for example, @samp{9600}).
11624
11625@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11626If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11627specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11628@end table
11629
11630@node Hitachi Special
11631@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11632
11633Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11634
11635@table @code
11636
11637@kindex set machine
11638@kindex show machine
11639@item set machine h8300
11640@itemx set machine h8300h
11641Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11642architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11643to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11644
11645@end table
11646
8e04817f
AC
11647@node H8/500
11648@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11649
11650@table @code
11651
8e04817f
AC
11652@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11653@cindex memory models, H8/500
11654@item set memory @var{mod}
11655@itemx show memory
11656Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11657@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11658memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11659@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11660
8e04817f 11661@end table
104c1213 11662
8e04817f
AC
11663@node M32R/D
11664@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11665
11666@table @code
11667
11668@kindex target m32r
11669@item target m32r @var{dev}
11670Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11671
11672@end table
11673
11674@node M68K
11675@subsection M68k
11676
11677The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11678target command for the following ROM monitors.
11679
11680@table @code
11681
11682@kindex target abug
11683@item target abug @var{dev}
11684ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11685
11686@kindex target cpu32bug
11687@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11688CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11689
11690@kindex target dbug
11691@item target dbug @var{dev}
11692dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11693
11694@kindex target est
11695@item target est @var{dev}
11696EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11697
11698@kindex target rom68k
11699@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11700ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11701
11702@end table
11703
8e04817f
AC
11704@table @code
11705
11706@kindex target rombug
11707@item target rombug @var{dev}
11708ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11709
11710@end table
11711
8e04817f
AC
11712@node MIPS Embedded
11713@subsection MIPS Embedded
11714
11715@cindex MIPS boards
11716@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11717MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11718you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11719
8e04817f
AC
11720@need 1000
11721Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11722
8e04817f
AC
11723@table @code
11724@item target mips @var{port}
11725@kindex target mips @var{port}
11726To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11727name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11728command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11729the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11730been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11731download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11732
8e04817f
AC
11733For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11734port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11735debugger:
104c1213 11736
474c8240 11737@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
11738host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11739@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11740(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11741(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11742(@value{GDBP}) run
474c8240 11743@end smallexample
104c1213 11744
8e04817f
AC
11745@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11746On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11747connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11748concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11749@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11750
8e04817f
AC
11751@item target pmon @var{port}
11752@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11753PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11754
8e04817f
AC
11755@item target ddb @var{port}
11756@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11757NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11758
8e04817f
AC
11759@item target lsi @var{port}
11760@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11761LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11762
8e04817f
AC
11763@kindex target r3900
11764@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11765Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11766
8e04817f
AC
11767@kindex target array
11768@item target array @var{dev}
11769Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11770
8e04817f 11771@end table
104c1213 11772
104c1213 11773
8e04817f
AC
11774@noindent
11775@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11776
8e04817f
AC
11777@table @code
11778@item set processor @var{args}
11779@itemx show processor
11780@kindex set processor @var{args}
11781@kindex show processor
11782Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11783processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11784For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11785to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11786Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11787is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11788@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11789
8e04817f
AC
11790@item set mipsfpu double
11791@itemx set mipsfpu single
11792@itemx set mipsfpu none
11793@itemx show mipsfpu
11794@kindex set mipsfpu
11795@kindex show mipsfpu
11796@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11797@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11798If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11799coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11800need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11801file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11802functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11803@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11804functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11805with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11806processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11807double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11808@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11809
8e04817f
AC
11810In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11811floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11812and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11813
8e04817f
AC
11814As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11815@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11816
8e04817f
AC
11817@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11818@itemx show remotedebug
11819@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11820@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11821@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11822@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11823@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11824@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11825You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11826by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11827@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11828to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11829at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11830
8e04817f
AC
11831@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11832@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11833@itemx show timeout
11834@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11835@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11836@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11837@kindex set timeout
11838@kindex show timeout
11839@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11840@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11841You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11842remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11843default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11844waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11845retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11846You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11847retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11848@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11849
8e04817f
AC
11850The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11851is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11852forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11853to run before stopping.
11854@end table
104c1213 11855
a37295f9
MM
11856@node OpenRISC 1000
11857@subsection OpenRISC 1000
11858@cindex OpenRISC 1000
11859
11860@cindex or1k boards
11861See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
11862about platform and commands.
11863
11864@table @code
11865
11866@kindex target jtag
11867@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
11868
11869Connects to remote JTAG server.
11870JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
11871connected via parallel port to the board.
11872
11873Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
11874
11875@kindex or1ksim
11876@item or1ksim @var{command}
11877If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
11878Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
11879
11880@kindex info or1k spr
11881@item info or1k spr
11882Displays spr groups.
11883
11884@item info or1k spr @var{group}
11885@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
11886Displays register names in selected group.
11887
11888@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
11889@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
11890@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
11891@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
11892Shows information about specified spr register.
11893
11894@kindex spr
11895@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
11896@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
11897@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
11898@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
11899Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
11900@end table
11901
11902Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
11903It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
11904program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
11905triggers can be set using:
11906@table @code
11907@item $LEA/$LDATA
11908Load effective address/data
11909@item $SEA/$SDATA
11910Store effective address/data
11911@item $AEA/$ADATA
11912Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
11913@item $FETCH
11914Fetch data
11915@end table
11916
11917When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
11918@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
11919
11920@code{htrace} commands:
11921@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
11922@table @code
11923@kindex hwatch
11924@item hwatch @var{conditional}
11925Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
11926or Data. For example:
11927
11928@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11929
11930@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
11931
11932@kindex htrace info
11933@item htrace info
11934Display information about current HW trace configuration.
11935
11936@kindex htrace trigger
11937@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
11938Set starting criteria for HW trace.
11939
11940@kindex htrace qualifier
11941@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
11942Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
11943
11944@kindex htrace stop
11945@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
11946Set HW trace stopping criteria.
11947
11948@kindex htrace record
f153cc92 11949@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
a37295f9
MM
11950Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
11951triggered.
11952
11953@kindex htrace enable
11954@item htrace enable
11955@kindex htrace disable
11956@itemx htrace disable
11957Enables/disables the HW trace.
11958
11959@kindex htrace rewind
f153cc92 11960@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
a37295f9
MM
11961Clears currently recorded trace data.
11962
11963If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
11964will be written there.
11965
11966@kindex htrace print
f153cc92 11967@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
a37295f9
MM
11968Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
11969
11970@kindex htrace mode continuous
11971@item htrace mode continuous
11972Set continuous trace mode.
11973
11974@kindex htrace mode suspend
11975@item htrace mode suspend
11976Set suspend trace mode.
11977
11978@end table
11979
8e04817f
AC
11980@node PowerPC
11981@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11982
11983@table @code
104c1213 11984
8e04817f
AC
11985@kindex target dink32
11986@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11987DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11988
8e04817f
AC
11989@kindex target ppcbug
11990@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11991@kindex target ppcbug1
11992@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11993PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11994
8e04817f
AC
11995@kindex target sds
11996@item target sds @var{dev}
11997SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11998
11999@end table
12000
12001@node PA
12002@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
12003
12004@table @code
12005
8e04817f
AC
12006@kindex target op50n
12007@item target op50n @var{dev}
12008OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12009
12010@kindex target w89k
12011@item target w89k @var{dev}
12012W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
12013
12014@end table
12015
8e04817f
AC
12016@node SH
12017@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
12018
12019@table @code
12020
8e04817f
AC
12021@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12022@item target hms @var{dev}
12023A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12024commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12025the communications speed used.
104c1213 12026
8e04817f
AC
12027@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12028@item target e7000 @var{dev}
12029E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 12030
8e04817f
AC
12031@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12032@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12033@item target sh3 @var{dev}
12034@item target sh3e @var{dev}
12035Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 12036
8e04817f 12037@end table
104c1213 12038
8e04817f
AC
12039@node Sparclet
12040@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 12041
8e04817f
AC
12042@cindex Sparclet
12043
12044@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12045Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12046@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12047both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12048@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 12049
8e04817f
AC
12050@table @code
12051@item remotetimeout @var{args}
12052@kindex remotetimeout
12053@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12054This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12055seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
12056@end table
12057
8e04817f
AC
12058@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12059When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12060information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12061load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12062@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 12063
474c8240 12064@smallexample
8e04817f 12065sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
474c8240 12066@end smallexample
104c1213 12067
8e04817f 12068You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 12069
474c8240 12070@smallexample
8e04817f 12071sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
474c8240 12072@end smallexample
104c1213 12073
8e04817f
AC
12074@cindex running, on Sparclet
12075Once you have set
12076your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12077run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12078(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 12079
8e04817f
AC
12080@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12081
474c8240 12082@smallexample
8e04817f 12083(gdbslet)
474c8240 12084@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12085
12086@menu
8e04817f
AC
12087* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12088* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12089* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12090* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
12091@end menu
12092
8e04817f
AC
12093@node Sparclet File
12094@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 12095
8e04817f 12096The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213 12097
474c8240 12098@smallexample
8e04817f 12099(gdbslet) file prog
474c8240 12100@end smallexample
104c1213 12101
8e04817f
AC
12102@need 1000
12103@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12104@value{GDBN} locates
12105the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12106path.
12107If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12108files will be searched as well.
12109@value{GDBN} locates
12110the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12111path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12112If it fails
12113to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 12114
474c8240 12115@smallexample
8e04817f 12116prog: No such file or directory.
474c8240 12117@end smallexample
104c1213 12118
8e04817f
AC
12119When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12120the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12121@code{target} command again.
104c1213 12122
8e04817f
AC
12123@node Sparclet Connection
12124@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 12125
8e04817f
AC
12126The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12127To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 12128
474c8240 12129@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12130(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12131Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12132main () at ../prog.c:3
474c8240 12133@end smallexample
104c1213 12134
8e04817f
AC
12135@need 750
12136@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 12137
474c8240 12138@smallexample
8e04817f 12139Connected to ttya.
474c8240 12140@end smallexample
104c1213 12141
8e04817f
AC
12142@node Sparclet Download
12143@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 12144
8e04817f
AC
12145@cindex download to Sparclet
12146Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12147you can use the @value{GDBN}
12148@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12149The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12150command.
12151Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12152address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12153offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12154of each of the file's sections.
12155For instance, if the program
12156@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12157and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 12158
474c8240 12159@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12160(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12161Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
474c8240 12162@end smallexample
104c1213 12163
8e04817f
AC
12164If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12165to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12166to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12167
12168@node Sparclet Execution
12169@subsubsection Running and debugging
12170
12171@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12172You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12173commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12174manual for the list of commands.
12175
474c8240 12176@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12177(gdbslet) b main
12178Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12179(gdbslet) run
12180Starting program: prog
12181Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
121823 char *symarg = 0;
12183(gdbslet) step
121844 char *execarg = "hello!";
12185(gdbslet)
474c8240 12186@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12187
12188@node Sparclite
12189@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12190
12191@table @code
12192
8e04817f
AC
12193@kindex target sparclite
12194@item target sparclite @var{dev}
12195Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12196You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12197For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12198remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
12199
12200@end table
12201
8e04817f
AC
12202@node ST2000
12203@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 12204
8e04817f
AC
12205@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12206STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 12207
8e04817f
AC
12208To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12209manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 12210
474c8240 12211@smallexample
8e04817f 12212target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
474c8240 12213@end smallexample
104c1213 12214
8e04817f
AC
12215@noindent
12216to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12217the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12218ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12219connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12220concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 12221
8e04817f
AC
12222The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12223this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12224would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12225(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12226available on your host computer.
12227@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12228@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 12229
8e04817f
AC
12230@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12231These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12232environment:
104c1213 12233
8e04817f
AC
12234@table @code
12235@item st2000 @var{command}
12236@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12237@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12238@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12239Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12240manual for available commands.
104c1213 12241
8e04817f
AC
12242@item connect
12243@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12244Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12245you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12246sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12247@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12248@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
12249@end table
12250
8e04817f
AC
12251@node Z8000
12252@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 12253
8e04817f
AC
12254@cindex Z8000
12255@cindex simulator, Z8000
12256@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 12257
8e04817f
AC
12258When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12259a Z8000 simulator.
12260
12261For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12262unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12263segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12264appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 12265
8e04817f
AC
12266@table @code
12267@item target sim @var{args}
12268@kindex sim
12269@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12270Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12271options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
12272@end table
12273
8e04817f
AC
12274@noindent
12275After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12276CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12277@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12278to run your program, and so on.
12279
12280As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12281(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12282additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12283
12284@table @code
12285
8e04817f
AC
12286@item cycles
12287Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 12288
8e04817f
AC
12289@item insts
12290Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12291
8e04817f
AC
12292@item time
12293Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12294
8e04817f 12295@end table
104c1213 12296
8e04817f
AC
12297You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12298conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12299conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12300simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12301
8e04817f
AC
12302@node Architectures
12303@section Architectures
104c1213 12304
8e04817f
AC
12305This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12306all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12307
8e04817f
AC
12308@menu
12309* A29K::
12310* Alpha::
12311* MIPS::
12312@end menu
104c1213 12313
8e04817f
AC
12314@node A29K
12315@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12316
12317@table @code
104c1213 12318
8e04817f
AC
12319@kindex set rstack_high_address
12320@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12321@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12322@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12323On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12324@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12325extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12326stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12327memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12328this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12329the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12330address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12331hexadecimal.
104c1213 12332
8e04817f
AC
12333@kindex show rstack_high_address
12334@item show rstack_high_address
12335Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12336processors.
104c1213 12337
8e04817f 12338@end table
104c1213 12339
8e04817f
AC
12340@node Alpha
12341@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12342
8e04817f 12343See the following section.
104c1213 12344
8e04817f
AC
12345@node MIPS
12346@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12347
8e04817f
AC
12348@cindex stack on Alpha
12349@cindex stack on MIPS
12350@cindex Alpha stack
12351@cindex MIPS stack
12352Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12353sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12354find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12355
8e04817f
AC
12356@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12357To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12358@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12359you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12360commands:
104c1213 12361
8e04817f
AC
12362@table @code
12363@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12364@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12365Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12366search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12367default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12368larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12369and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12370
8e04817f
AC
12371@item show heuristic-fence-post
12372Display the current limit.
12373@end table
104c1213
JM
12374
12375@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12376These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12377for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12378
104c1213 12379
8e04817f
AC
12380@node Controlling GDB
12381@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12382
12383You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12384@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12385data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12386described here.
12387
12388@menu
12389* Prompt:: Prompt
12390* Editing:: Command editing
12391* History:: Command history
12392* Screen Size:: Screen size
12393* Numbers:: Numbers
1e698235 12394* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
8e04817f
AC
12395* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12396* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12397@end menu
12398
12399@node Prompt
12400@section Prompt
104c1213 12401
8e04817f 12402@cindex prompt
104c1213 12403
8e04817f
AC
12404@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12405called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12406can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12407instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12408the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12409which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12410
8e04817f
AC
12411@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12412prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12413or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12414
8e04817f
AC
12415@table @code
12416@kindex set prompt
12417@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12418Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12419
8e04817f
AC
12420@kindex show prompt
12421@item show prompt
12422Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12423@end table
12424
8e04817f
AC
12425@node Editing
12426@section Command editing
12427@cindex readline
12428@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12429
8e04817f
AC
12430@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12431@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12432command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12433or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12434substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12435debugging sessions.
104c1213 12436
8e04817f
AC
12437You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12438command @code{set}.
104c1213 12439
8e04817f
AC
12440@table @code
12441@kindex set editing
12442@cindex editing
12443@item set editing
12444@itemx set editing on
12445Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12446
8e04817f
AC
12447@item set editing off
12448Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12449
8e04817f
AC
12450@kindex show editing
12451@item show editing
12452Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12453@end table
12454
8e04817f
AC
12455@node History
12456@section Command history
12457
12458@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12459debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12460happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12461history facility.
104c1213
JM
12462
12463@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12464@cindex history substitution
12465@cindex history file
12466@kindex set history filename
12467@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12468@item set history filename @var{fname}
12469Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12470This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12471list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12472exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12473the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12474to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12475@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12476is not set.
104c1213 12477
8e04817f
AC
12478@cindex history save
12479@kindex set history save
12480@item set history save
12481@itemx set history save on
12482Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12483@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12484
8e04817f
AC
12485@item set history save off
12486Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12487
8e04817f
AC
12488@cindex history size
12489@kindex set history size
12490@item set history size @var{size}
12491Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12492This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12493@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12494@end table
12495
8e04817f
AC
12496@cindex history expansion
12497History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12498@ifset have-readline-appendices
12499@xref{Event Designators}.
12500@end ifset
12501
12502Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12503is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12504@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12505follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12506a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12507history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12508@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12509
12510The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12511
12512@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12513@kindex set history expansion
12514@item set history expansion on
12515@itemx set history expansion
12516Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12517
8e04817f
AC
12518@item set history expansion off
12519Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12520
8e04817f
AC
12521The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12522editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12523or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12524@ifset have-readline-appendices
12525@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12526@end ifset
104c1213 12527
8e04817f
AC
12528@c @group
12529@kindex show history
12530@item show history
12531@itemx show history filename
12532@itemx show history save
12533@itemx show history size
12534@itemx show history expansion
12535These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12536@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12537@c @end group
12538@end table
12539
12540@table @code
12541@kindex shows
12542@item show commands
12543Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12544
8e04817f
AC
12545@item show commands @var{n}
12546Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12547
12548@item show commands +
12549Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12550@end table
12551
8e04817f
AC
12552@node Screen Size
12553@section Screen size
12554@cindex size of screen
12555@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12556
8e04817f
AC
12557Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12558information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12559@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12560output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12561to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12562determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12563printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12564rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12565
12566Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12567driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12568together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12569@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12570you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12571width} commands:
12572
12573@table @code
12574@kindex set height
12575@kindex set width
12576@kindex show width
12577@kindex show height
12578@item set height @var{lpp}
12579@itemx show height
12580@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12581@itemx show width
12582These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12583a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12584commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12585
8e04817f
AC
12586If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12587output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12588file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12589
8e04817f
AC
12590Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12591from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12592@end table
12593
8e04817f
AC
12594@node Numbers
12595@section Numbers
12596@cindex number representation
12597@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12598
8e04817f
AC
12599You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12600@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12601@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12602begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12603default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12604numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12605change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12606radix} command.
104c1213 12607
8e04817f
AC
12608@table @code
12609@kindex set input-radix
12610@item set input-radix @var{base}
12611Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12612for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12613specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12614example, any of
104c1213 12615
8e04817f
AC
12616@smallexample
12617set radix 012
12618set radix 10.
12619set radix 0xa
12620@end smallexample
104c1213 12621
8e04817f
AC
12622@noindent
12623sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12624leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12625
8e04817f
AC
12626@kindex set output-radix
12627@item set output-radix @var{base}
12628Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12629for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12630specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12631
8e04817f
AC
12632@kindex show input-radix
12633@item show input-radix
12634Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12635
8e04817f
AC
12636@kindex show output-radix
12637@item show output-radix
12638Display the current default base for numeric display.
12639@end table
104c1213 12640
1e698235
DJ
12641@node ABI
12642@section Configuring the current ABI
12643
12644@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12645application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12646conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12647current ABI.
12648
98b45e30
DJ
12649@cindex OS ABI
12650@kindex set osabi
b4e9345d 12651@kindex show osabi
98b45e30
DJ
12652
12653One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12654system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12655@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12656but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12657One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12658an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12659not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12660platform provides.
12661
12662@table @code
12663@item show osabi
12664Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12665
12666@item set osabi
12667With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12668
12669@item set osabi @var{abi}
12670Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12671@end table
12672
1e698235
DJ
12673@cindex float promotion
12674@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12675
12676Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12677function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12678(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12679according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12680(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12681@code{double} and then passed.
12682
12683Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12684a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12685as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12686
12687@table @code
12688@item set coerce-float-to-double
12689@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12690Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12691to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12692
12693@item set coerce-float-to-double off
12694Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12695functions.
12696@end table
12697
8e04817f
AC
12698@node Messages/Warnings
12699@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12700
8e04817f
AC
12701By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12702running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12703command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12704internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12705
8e04817f
AC
12706Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12707which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12708see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12709
8e04817f
AC
12710@table @code
12711@kindex set verbose
12712@item set verbose on
12713Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12714
8e04817f
AC
12715@item set verbose off
12716Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12717
8e04817f
AC
12718@kindex show verbose
12719@item show verbose
12720Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12721@end table
104c1213 12722
8e04817f
AC
12723By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12724object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12725find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12726symbol files}).
104c1213 12727
8e04817f 12728@table @code
104c1213 12729
8e04817f
AC
12730@kindex set complaints
12731@item set complaints @var{limit}
12732Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12733unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12734@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12735to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12736
8e04817f
AC
12737@kindex show complaints
12738@item show complaints
12739Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12740
8e04817f 12741@end table
104c1213 12742
8e04817f
AC
12743By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12744lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12745you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213 12746
474c8240 12747@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
12748(@value{GDBP}) run
12749The program being debugged has been started already.
12750Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
474c8240 12751@end smallexample
104c1213 12752
8e04817f
AC
12753If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12754commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12755
8e04817f 12756@table @code
104c1213 12757
8e04817f
AC
12758@kindex set confirm
12759@cindex flinching
12760@cindex confirmation
12761@cindex stupid questions
12762@item set confirm off
12763Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12764
8e04817f
AC
12765@item set confirm on
12766Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12767
8e04817f
AC
12768@kindex show confirm
12769@item show confirm
12770Displays state of confirmation requests.
12771
12772@end table
104c1213 12773
8e04817f
AC
12774@node Debugging Output
12775@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12776@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12777@kindex set debug arch
12778@item set debug arch
12779Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12780@kindex show debug arch
12781@item show debug arch
12782Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12783@kindex set debug event
12784@item set debug event
12785Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12786default is off.
12787@kindex show debug event
12788@item show debug event
12789Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12790info.
12791@kindex set debug expression
12792@item set debug expression
12793Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12794default is off.
12795@kindex show debug expression
12796@item show debug expression
12797Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12798debugging info.
12799@kindex set debug overload
12800@item set debug overload
12801Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12802info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12803is off.
12804@kindex show debug overload
12805@item show debug overload
12806Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12807debugging info.
12808@kindex set debug remote
12809@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12810@cindex serial connections, debugging
12811@item set debug remote
12812Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12813the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12814@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12815@kindex show debug remote
12816@item show debug remote
12817Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12818@kindex set debug serial
12819@item set debug serial
12820Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12821default is off.
12822@kindex show debug serial
12823@item show debug serial
12824Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12825info.
12826@kindex set debug target
12827@item set debug target
12828Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12829includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12830default is off.
12831@kindex show debug target
12832@item show debug target
12833Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12834info.
12835@kindex set debug varobj
12836@item set debug varobj
12837Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12838info. The default is off.
12839@kindex show debug varobj
12840@item show debug varobj
12841Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12842debugging info.
12843@end table
104c1213 12844
8e04817f
AC
12845@node Sequences
12846@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12847
8e04817f
AC
12848Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12849command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12850commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12851files.
104c1213 12852
8e04817f
AC
12853@menu
12854* Define:: User-defined commands
12855* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12856* Command Files:: Command files
12857* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12858@end menu
104c1213 12859
8e04817f
AC
12860@node Define
12861@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12862
8e04817f
AC
12863@cindex user-defined command
12864A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12865which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12866@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12867separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12868via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12869
8e04817f
AC
12870@smallexample
12871define adder
12872 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12873@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12874
12875@noindent
8e04817f 12876To execute the command use:
104c1213 12877
8e04817f
AC
12878@smallexample
12879adder 1 2 3
12880@end smallexample
104c1213 12881
8e04817f
AC
12882@noindent
12883This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12884its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12885reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12886functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12887
12888@table @code
104c1213 12889
8e04817f
AC
12890@kindex define
12891@item define @var{commandname}
12892Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12893by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12894
8e04817f
AC
12895The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12896which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12897commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12898
8e04817f
AC
12899@kindex if
12900@kindex else
12901@item if
12902Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12903It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12904only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12905There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12906by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12907was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12908
8e04817f
AC
12909@kindex while
12910@item while
12911The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12912which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12913execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12914The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12915evaluates to true.
104c1213 12916
8e04817f
AC
12917@kindex document
12918@item document @var{commandname}
12919Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12920accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12921defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12922reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12923After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12924@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12925
8e04817f
AC
12926You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12927documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12928does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12929
8e04817f
AC
12930@kindex help user-defined
12931@item help user-defined
12932List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12933(if any) for each.
104c1213 12934
8e04817f
AC
12935@kindex show user
12936@item show user
12937@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12938Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12939not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12940definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213 12941
20f01a46
DH
12942@kindex show max-user-call-depth
12943@kindex set max-user-call-depth
12944@item show max-user-call-depth
5ca0cb28
DH
12945@itemx set max-user-call-depth
12946The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
12947levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
12948infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20f01a46 12949
104c1213
JM
12950@end table
12951
8e04817f
AC
12952When user-defined commands are executed, the
12953commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12954stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12955
8e04817f
AC
12956If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12957without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12958commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12959messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12960
8e04817f
AC
12961@node Hooks
12962@section User-defined command hooks
12963@cindex command hooks
12964@cindex hooks, for commands
12965@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12966
8e04817f
AC
12967@kindex hook
12968@kindex hook-
12969You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12970command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12971command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12972before that command.
104c1213 12973
8e04817f
AC
12974@cindex hooks, post-command
12975@kindex hookpost
12976@kindex hookpost-
12977A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12978Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12979@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12980that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12981pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12982
8e04817f
AC
12983It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12984occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12985
8e04817f
AC
12986@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12987@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12988
8e04817f
AC
12989@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12990In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12991(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12992execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12993displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12994
8e04817f
AC
12995For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12996single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12997you could define:
104c1213 12998
474c8240 12999@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13000define hook-stop
13001handle SIGALRM nopass
13002end
104c1213 13003
8e04817f
AC
13004define hook-run
13005handle SIGALRM pass
13006end
104c1213 13007
8e04817f
AC
13008define hook-continue
13009handle SIGLARM pass
13010end
474c8240 13011@end smallexample
104c1213 13012
8e04817f
AC
13013As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13014command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13015you could define:
104c1213 13016
474c8240 13017@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13018define hook-echo
13019echo <<<---
13020end
104c1213 13021
8e04817f
AC
13022define hookpost-echo
13023echo --->>>\n
13024end
104c1213 13025
8e04817f
AC
13026(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13027<<<---Hello World--->>>
13028(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 13029
474c8240 13030@end smallexample
104c1213 13031
8e04817f
AC
13032You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13033not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13034name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13035@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13036@c or not?
13037If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13038@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13039(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 13040
8e04817f
AC
13041If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13042get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 13043
8e04817f
AC
13044@node Command Files
13045@section Command files
c906108c 13046
8e04817f
AC
13047@cindex command files
13048A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13049commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13050An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13051the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 13052
8e04817f
AC
13053@cindex init file
13054@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13055@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13056When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13057@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13058port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13059limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13060During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 13061
8e04817f
AC
13062@enumerate
13063@item
13064Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13065DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13066@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 13067
8e04817f
AC
13068@item
13069Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 13070
8e04817f
AC
13071@item
13072Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 13073
8e04817f
AC
13074@item
13075Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13076@end enumerate
c906108c 13077
8e04817f
AC
13078The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13079complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13080and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13081option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 13082
8e04817f
AC
13083@cindex init file name
13084On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13085different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13086form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13087different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13088environments with special init file names:
c906108c 13089
8e04817f
AC
13090@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13091@itemize @bullet
13092@item
13093VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 13094
8e04817f
AC
13095@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13096@item
13097OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 13098
8e04817f
AC
13099@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13100@item
13101ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13102@end itemize
c906108c 13103
8e04817f
AC
13104You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13105@code{source} command:
c906108c 13106
8e04817f
AC
13107@table @code
13108@kindex source
13109@item source @var{filename}
13110Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
13111@end table
13112
8e04817f 13113The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
a71ec265
DH
13114printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13115execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
c906108c 13116
8e04817f
AC
13117Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13118without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13119normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13120when called from command files.
c906108c 13121
8e04817f
AC
13122@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13123mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13124standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13125not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13126the next command.
c906108c 13127
474c8240 13128@smallexample
8e04817f 13129gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
474c8240 13130@end smallexample
c906108c 13131
8e04817f
AC
13132(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13133will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13134would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 13135
8e04817f
AC
13136@node Output
13137@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 13138
8e04817f
AC
13139During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13140@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13141explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13142describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13143want.
c906108c
SS
13144
13145@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13146@kindex echo
13147@item echo @var{text}
13148@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13149@c because it is not in ANSI.
13150Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13151@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13152newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13153In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13154by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13155string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13156trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13157To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13158@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 13159
8e04817f
AC
13160A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13161the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 13162
474c8240 13163@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13164echo This is some text\n\
13165which is continued\n\
13166onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13167@end smallexample
c906108c 13168
8e04817f 13169produces the same output as
c906108c 13170
474c8240 13171@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13172echo This is some text\n
13173echo which is continued\n
13174echo onto several lines.\n
474c8240 13175@end smallexample
c906108c 13176
8e04817f
AC
13177@kindex output
13178@item output @var{expression}
13179Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13180newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13181value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13182on expressions.
c906108c 13183
8e04817f
AC
13184@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13185Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13186the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13187formats}, for more information.
c906108c 13188
8e04817f
AC
13189@kindex printf
13190@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13191Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13192@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13193either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13194@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13195subroutine
13196@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13197@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13198@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13199@c supported.
c906108c 13200
474c8240 13201@smallexample
8e04817f 13202printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
474c8240 13203@end smallexample
c906108c 13204
8e04817f 13205For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 13206
8e04817f
AC
13207@smallexample
13208printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13209@end smallexample
c906108c 13210
8e04817f
AC
13211The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13212string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13213letter.
c906108c
SS
13214@end table
13215
8e04817f
AC
13216@node TUI
13217@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13218@cindex TUI
c906108c 13219
8e04817f
AC
13220@menu
13221* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13222* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
7cf36c78 13223* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
8e04817f
AC
13224* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13225* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13226@end menu
c906108c 13227
8e04817f
AC
13228The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13229is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13230to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13231and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13232The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13233with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 13234
8e04817f
AC
13235@node TUI Overview
13236@section TUI overview
c906108c 13237
8e04817f
AC
13238The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13239@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 13240
8e04817f
AC
13241@itemize @bullet
13242@item
13243A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13244windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13245
8e04817f
AC
13246@item
13247A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13248the TUI.
13249@end itemize
c906108c 13250
8e04817f
AC
13251In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13252on the terminal:
c906108c 13253
8e04817f
AC
13254@table @emph
13255@item command
13256This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13257prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13258managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13259window is always visible.
c906108c 13260
8e04817f
AC
13261@item source
13262The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13263line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
c906108c 13264
8e04817f
AC
13265@item assembly
13266The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 13267
8e04817f
AC
13268@item register
13269This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13270a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13271changed are highlighted.
c906108c 13272
c906108c
SS
13273@end table
13274
269c21fe
SC
13275The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13276by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13277Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13278indicates the breakpoint type:
13279
13280@table @code
13281@item B
13282Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13283
13284@item b
13285Breakpoint which was never hit.
13286
13287@item H
13288Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13289
13290@item h
13291Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13292
13293@end table
13294
13295The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13296
13297@table @code
13298@item +
13299Breakpoint is enabled.
13300
13301@item -
13302Breakpoint is disabled.
13303
13304@end table
13305
8e04817f
AC
13306The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13307and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13308changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13309These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13310layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13311The following layouts are available:
c906108c 13312
8e04817f
AC
13313@itemize @bullet
13314@item
13315source
2df3850c 13316
8e04817f
AC
13317@item
13318assembly
13319
13320@item
13321source and assembly
13322
13323@item
13324source and registers
c906108c 13325
8e04817f
AC
13326@item
13327assembly and registers
2df3850c 13328
8e04817f 13329@end itemize
c906108c 13330
b7bb15bc
SC
13331On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13332concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13333updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13334are displayed:
13335
13336@table @emph
13337@item target
13338Indicates the current gdb target
13339(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13340
13341@item process
13342Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13343When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13344
13345@item function
13346Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13347The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13348When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13349the string @code{??} is displayed.
13350
13351@item line
13352Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13353When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13354
13355@item pc
13356Indicates the current program counter address.
13357
13358@end table
13359
8e04817f
AC
13360@node TUI Keys
13361@section TUI Key Bindings
13362@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 13363
8e04817f
AC
13364The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13365(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13366They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
7cf36c78
SC
13367directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13368a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13369@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
8e04817f 13370are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 13371
8e04817f
AC
13372@table @kbd
13373@kindex C-x C-a
13374@item C-x C-a
13375@kindex C-x a
13376@itemx C-x a
13377@kindex C-x A
13378@itemx C-x A
13379Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13380the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13381its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13382mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13383The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 13384
8e04817f
AC
13385@kindex C-x 1
13386@item C-x 1
13387Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13388either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13389is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 13390
8e04817f 13391Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 13392
8e04817f
AC
13393@kindex C-x 2
13394@item C-x 2
13395Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13396layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13397When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13398previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 13399
8e04817f 13400Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 13401
7cf36c78
SC
13402@kindex C-x s
13403@item C-x s
13404Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13405(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13406
c906108c
SS
13407@end table
13408
8e04817f 13409The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 13410
8e04817f
AC
13411@table @key
13412@kindex PgUp
13413@item PgUp
13414Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 13415
8e04817f
AC
13416@kindex PgDn
13417@item PgDn
13418Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 13419
8e04817f
AC
13420@kindex Up
13421@item Up
13422Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13423
8e04817f
AC
13424@kindex Down
13425@item Down
13426Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13427
8e04817f
AC
13428@kindex Left
13429@item Left
13430Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13431
8e04817f
AC
13432@kindex Right
13433@item Right
13434Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13435
8e04817f
AC
13436@kindex C-L
13437@item C-L
13438Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13439
8e04817f 13440@end table
c906108c 13441
8e04817f
AC
13442In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13443for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13444necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13445@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13446
7cf36c78
SC
13447@node TUI Single Key Mode
13448@section TUI Single Key Mode
13449@cindex TUI single key mode
13450
13451The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13452key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13453some gdb commands.
13454
13455@table @kbd
13456@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13457@item c
13458continue
13459
13460@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13461@item d
13462down
13463
13464@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13465@item f
13466finish
13467
13468@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13469@item n
13470next
13471
13472@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13473@item q
13474exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13475
13476@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13477@item r
13478run
13479
13480@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13481@item s
13482step
13483
13484@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13485@item u
13486up
13487
13488@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13489@item v
13490info locals
13491
13492@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13493@item w
13494where
13495
13496@end table
13497
13498Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13499The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13500it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13501with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13502@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13503this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13504
13505
8e04817f
AC
13506@node TUI Commands
13507@section TUI specific commands
13508@cindex TUI commands
13509
13510The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13511These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13512the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13513is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13514in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13515
13516@table @code
3d757584
SC
13517@item info win
13518@kindex info win
13519List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13520
8e04817f
AC
13521@item layout next
13522@kindex layout next
13523Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13524
8e04817f
AC
13525@item layout prev
13526@kindex layout prev
13527Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13528
8e04817f
AC
13529@item layout src
13530@kindex layout src
13531Display the source window only.
c906108c 13532
8e04817f
AC
13533@item layout asm
13534@kindex layout asm
13535Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13536
8e04817f
AC
13537@item layout split
13538@kindex layout split
13539Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13540
8e04817f
AC
13541@item layout regs
13542@kindex layout regs
13543Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13544
13545@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13546@kindex focus
13547Set the focus to the named window.
13548This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13549can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13550
8e04817f
AC
13551@item refresh
13552@kindex refresh
13553Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13554
8e04817f
AC
13555@item update
13556@kindex update
13557Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13558
8e04817f
AC
13559@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13560@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13561@kindex winheight
13562Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13563lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13564decrease it.
2df3850c 13565
c906108c
SS
13566@end table
13567
8e04817f
AC
13568@node TUI Configuration
13569@section TUI configuration variables
13570@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13571
8e04817f
AC
13572The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13573appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13574
8e04817f
AC
13575@table @code
13576@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13577@kindex set tui border-kind
13578Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13579The possible values are the following:
13580@table @code
13581@item space
13582Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13583
8e04817f
AC
13584@item ascii
13585Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13586
8e04817f
AC
13587@item acs
13588Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13589drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13590
8e04817f 13591@end table
c78b4128 13592
8e04817f
AC
13593@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13594@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13595Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13596The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13597@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13598
8e04817f
AC
13599@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13600@kindex set tui border-mode
13601Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13602The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13603@table @code
13604@item normal
13605Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13606
8e04817f
AC
13607@item standout
13608Use standout mode.
c906108c 13609
8e04817f
AC
13610@item reverse
13611Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13612
8e04817f
AC
13613@item half
13614Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13615
8e04817f
AC
13616@item half-standout
13617Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13618
8e04817f
AC
13619@item bold
13620Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13621
8e04817f
AC
13622@item bold-standout
13623Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13624
8e04817f 13625@end table
c78b4128 13626
8e04817f 13627@end table
c78b4128 13628
8e04817f
AC
13629@node Emacs
13630@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13631
8e04817f
AC
13632@cindex Emacs
13633@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13634A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13635edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13636@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13637
8e04817f
AC
13638To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13639executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13640@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13641created Emacs buffer.
13642@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13643
8e04817f
AC
13644Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13645things:
c906108c 13646
8e04817f
AC
13647@itemize @bullet
13648@item
13649All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13650@end itemize
c906108c 13651
8e04817f
AC
13652This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13653and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13654
8e04817f
AC
13655This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13656commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13657in this way.
bf0184be 13658
8e04817f
AC
13659All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13660with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13661way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13662stop.
bf0184be 13663
8e04817f 13664@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13665@item
8e04817f
AC
13666@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13667@end itemize
bf0184be 13668
8e04817f
AC
13669Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13670source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13671left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13672source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13673and the source.
bf0184be 13674
8e04817f
AC
13675Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13676usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13677
8e04817f
AC
13678@quotation
13679@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13680current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13681the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13682appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13683environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13684session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13685back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13686avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13687your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13688@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13689
8e04817f
AC
13690A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13691switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13692@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13693@end quotation
13694
13695By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13696you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13697several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13698Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13699
474c8240 13700@smallexample
8e04817f 13701(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
474c8240 13702@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
13703
13704@noindent
13705(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13706in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13707``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13708
13709In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13710addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13711
8e04817f
AC
13712@table @kbd
13713@item C-h m
13714Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13715
8e04817f
AC
13716@item M-s
13717Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13718update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13719
8e04817f
AC
13720@item M-n
13721Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13722calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13723to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13724
8e04817f
AC
13725@item M-i
13726Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13727display window accordingly.
c906108c 13728
8e04817f
AC
13729@item M-x gdb-nexti
13730Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13731display window accordingly.
c906108c 13732
8e04817f
AC
13733@item C-c C-f
13734Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13735@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13736
8e04817f
AC
13737@item M-c
13738Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13739command.
b433d00b 13740
8e04817f 13741@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13742
8e04817f
AC
13743@item M-u
13744Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13745(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13746like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13747
8e04817f 13748@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13749
8e04817f
AC
13750@item M-d
13751Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13752@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13753
8e04817f 13754@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13755
8e04817f
AC
13756@item C-x &
13757Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13758of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13759around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13760then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13761argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13762
8e04817f
AC
13763You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13764@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13765otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13766inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13767wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13768list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13769formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13770is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13771@end table
c906108c 13772
8e04817f
AC
13773In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13774tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13775
8e04817f
AC
13776If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13777it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13778request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13779the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13780frame.
c906108c 13781
8e04817f
AC
13782The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13783which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13784the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13785communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13786delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13787to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13788
8e04817f
AC
13789@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13790@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13791@ignore
13792@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13793@kindex Epoch
13794@kindex inspect
c906108c 13795
8e04817f
AC
13796Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13797called the @code{epoch}
13798environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13799@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13800each value is printed in its own window.
13801@end ignore
c906108c 13802
8e04817f
AC
13803@include annotate.texi
13804@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13805
8e04817f
AC
13806@node GDB Bugs
13807@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13808@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13809@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13810
8e04817f 13811Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13812
8e04817f
AC
13813Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13814may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13815the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13816reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13817
8e04817f
AC
13818In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13819information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13820
13821@menu
8e04817f
AC
13822* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13823* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13824@end menu
13825
8e04817f
AC
13826@node Bug Criteria
13827@section Have you found a bug?
13828@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13829
8e04817f 13830If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13831
13832@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13833@cindex fatal signal
13834@cindex debugger crash
13835@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13836@item
8e04817f
AC
13837If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13838@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13839
13840@cindex error on valid input
13841@item
13842If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13843bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13844somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13845
8e04817f 13846@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13847@item
8e04817f
AC
13848If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13849that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13850``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13851for traditional practice''.
13852
13853@item
13854If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13855for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13856@end itemize
13857
8e04817f
AC
13858@node Bug Reporting
13859@section How to report bugs
13860@cindex bug reports
13861@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13862
13863A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13864If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13865contact that organization first.
13866
13867You can find contact information for many support companies and
13868individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13869distribution.
13870@c should add a web page ref...
13871
129188f6
AC
13872In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13873@value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13874@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13875page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13876be used.
8e04817f
AC
13877
13878@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13879@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13880not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13881@samp{bug-gdb}.
13882
13883The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13884serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13885the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13886newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13887problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13888path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13889we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13890bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13891
8e04817f
AC
13892The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13893@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13894fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13895
8e04817f
AC
13896Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13897problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13898assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13899Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13900stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13901name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13902of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13903the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13904easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13905
8e04817f
AC
13906Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13907bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13908you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13909self-contained.
c4555f82 13910
8e04817f
AC
13911Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13912bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13913@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13914bugs properly.
13915
13916To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13917
13918@itemize @bullet
13919@item
8e04817f
AC
13920The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13921with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13922version}.
c4555f82 13923
8e04817f
AC
13924Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13925the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13926
13927@item
8e04817f
AC
13928The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13929version number.
c4555f82
SC
13930
13931@item
8e04817f
AC
13932What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13933``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13934
13935@item
8e04817f
AC
13936What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13937debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13938C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13939information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13940compilers.
c4555f82 13941
8e04817f
AC
13942@item
13943The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13944observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13945you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13946Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13947
8e04817f
AC
13948If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13949and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13950
8e04817f
AC
13951@item
13952A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13953reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13954
8e04817f
AC
13955@item
13956A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13957incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13958
8e04817f
AC
13959Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13960will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13961not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13962a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13963
8e04817f
AC
13964Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13965say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13966copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13967the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13968crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13969ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13970us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13971to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13972
8e04817f
AC
13973@item
13974If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13975diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13976it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13977
8e04817f
AC
13978The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13979sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13980
8e04817f 13981@end itemize
c4555f82 13982
8e04817f 13983Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13984
8e04817f
AC
13985@itemize @bullet
13986@item
13987A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13988
8e04817f
AC
13989Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13990which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13991changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13992
8e04817f
AC
13993This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13994will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13995with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13996We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13997
8e04817f
AC
13998Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13999of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
14000output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
14001less time, and so on.
c4555f82 14002
8e04817f
AC
14003However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
14004report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 14005
8e04817f
AC
14006@item
14007A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 14008
8e04817f
AC
14009A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
14010the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
14011a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
14012to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 14013
8e04817f
AC
14014Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
14015construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
14016through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
14017to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 14018
8e04817f
AC
14019And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
14020patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
14021help us to understand.
c4555f82 14022
8e04817f
AC
14023@item
14024A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 14025
8e04817f
AC
14026Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
14027things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
14028@end itemize
c4555f82 14029
8e04817f
AC
14030@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
14031@c and consists of the two following files:
14032@c rluser.texinfo
14033@c inc-hist.texinfo
14034@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
14035@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
14036@include rluser.texinfo
14037@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 14038
c4555f82 14039
8e04817f
AC
14040@node Formatting Documentation
14041@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 14042
8e04817f
AC
14043@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
14044@cindex reference card
14045The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
14046for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
14047subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
14048@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
14049release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
14050you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 14051
8e04817f
AC
14052The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
14053can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 14054
474c8240 14055@smallexample
8e04817f 14056make refcard.dvi
474c8240 14057@end smallexample
c4555f82 14058
8e04817f
AC
14059The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
14060mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
14061that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
14062high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
14063your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 14064
8e04817f 14065@cindex documentation
c4555f82 14066
8e04817f
AC
14067All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
14068distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
14069a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
14070on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
14071formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
14072and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 14073
8e04817f
AC
14074@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
14075version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
14076file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
14077subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
14078necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
14079but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
14080Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
14081@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 14082
8e04817f
AC
14083If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
14084Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
14085@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 14086
8e04817f
AC
14087If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
14088@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
14089version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 14090
474c8240 14091@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14092cd gdb
14093make gdb.info
474c8240 14094@end smallexample
c4555f82 14095
8e04817f
AC
14096If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
14097a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
14098Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 14099
8e04817f
AC
14100@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
14101produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
14102document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
14103has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
14104command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14105(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14106require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 14107
8e04817f
AC
14108@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14109@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14110written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14111typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14112and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14113directory.
c4555f82 14114
8e04817f
AC
14115If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14116typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14117subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14118@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 14119
474c8240 14120@smallexample
8e04817f 14121make gdb.dvi
474c8240 14122@end smallexample
c4555f82 14123
8e04817f 14124Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 14125
8e04817f
AC
14126@node Installing GDB
14127@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14128@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14129@cindex installation
94e91d6d 14130@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
c4555f82 14131
8e04817f
AC
14132@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14133of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14134build the @code{gdb} program.
14135@iftex
14136@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14137@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14138look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14139installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14140@end iftex
c4555f82 14141
8e04817f
AC
14142The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14143@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14144appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 14145
8e04817f
AC
14146For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14147@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 14148
8e04817f
AC
14149@table @code
14150@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14151script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 14152
8e04817f
AC
14153@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14154the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 14155
8e04817f
AC
14156@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14157source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 14158
8e04817f
AC
14159@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14160@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 14161
8e04817f
AC
14162@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14163source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 14164
8e04817f
AC
14165@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14166source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 14167
8e04817f
AC
14168@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14169source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 14170
8e04817f
AC
14171@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14172source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 14173
8e04817f
AC
14174@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14175source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14176@end table
c906108c 14177
8e04817f
AC
14178The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14179from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14180this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 14181
8e04817f
AC
14182First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14183if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14184identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14185argument.
c906108c 14186
8e04817f 14187For example:
c906108c 14188
474c8240 14189@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14190cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14191./configure @var{host}
14192make
474c8240 14193@end smallexample
c906108c 14194
8e04817f
AC
14195@noindent
14196where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14197@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14198(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14199correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 14200
8e04817f
AC
14201Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14202@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14203libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14204binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 14205
8e04817f
AC
14206@need 750
14207@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14208system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14209shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c 14210
474c8240 14211@smallexample
8e04817f 14212sh configure @var{host}
474c8240 14213@end smallexample
c906108c 14214
8e04817f
AC
14215If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14216directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14217@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14218creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14219you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14220
94e91d6d
MC
14221You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
14222source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
14223@code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
14224that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
14225if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
14226of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
14227configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
14228directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
14229about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
c906108c 14230
8e04817f
AC
14231You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14232However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14233the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14234that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14235let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 14236
8e04817f
AC
14237@menu
14238* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14239* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14240* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14241@end menu
c906108c 14242
8e04817f
AC
14243@node Separate Objdir
14244@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 14245
8e04817f
AC
14246If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14247you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14248host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14249allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14250rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14251handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14252@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14253program specified there.
c906108c 14254
8e04817f
AC
14255To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14256with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14257(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14258itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14259would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14260the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 14261
8e04817f
AC
14262For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14263separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 14264
474c8240 14265@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14266@group
14267cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14268mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14269cd ../gdb-sun4
14270../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14271make
14272@end group
474c8240 14273@end smallexample
c906108c 14274
8e04817f
AC
14275When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14276directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14277(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14278the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14279directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14280@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 14281
94e91d6d
MC
14282Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
14283instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
14284like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
14285one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
14286build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
14287
8e04817f
AC
14288One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14289directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14290@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14291programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14292You specify a cross-debugging target by
14293giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 14294
8e04817f
AC
14295When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14296it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14297called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 14298
8e04817f
AC
14299The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14300directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14301directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14302directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14303will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 14304
8e04817f
AC
14305When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14306directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14307if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14308with each other.
c906108c 14309
8e04817f
AC
14310@node Config Names
14311@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 14312
8e04817f
AC
14313The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14314script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14315aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14316of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 14317
474c8240 14318@smallexample
8e04817f 14319@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
474c8240 14320@end smallexample
c906108c 14321
8e04817f
AC
14322For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14323or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14324option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 14325
8e04817f
AC
14326The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14327any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14328aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14329@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14330script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14331abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 14332
8e04817f
AC
14333@smallexample
14334% sh config.sub i386-linux
14335i386-pc-linux-gnu
14336% sh config.sub alpha-linux
14337alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14338% sh config.sub hp9k700
14339hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14340% sh config.sub sun4
14341sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14342% sh config.sub sun3
14343m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14344% sh config.sub i986v
14345Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14346@end smallexample
c906108c 14347
8e04817f
AC
14348@noindent
14349@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14350directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 14351
8e04817f
AC
14352@node Configure Options
14353@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 14354
8e04817f
AC
14355Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14356are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14357several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14358Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 14359
474c8240 14360@smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14361configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14362 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14363 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14364 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14365 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14366 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14367 @var{host}
474c8240 14368@end smallexample
c906108c 14369
8e04817f
AC
14370@noindent
14371You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14372@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14373@samp{--}.
c906108c 14374
8e04817f
AC
14375@table @code
14376@item --help
14377Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 14378
8e04817f
AC
14379@item --prefix=@var{dir}
14380Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14381@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14382
8e04817f
AC
14383@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14384Configure the source to install programs under directory
14385@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 14386
8e04817f
AC
14387@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14388@need 2000
14389@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14390@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14391@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14392Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14393@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14394build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14395directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14396the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14397directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14398the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14399@var{dirname}.
c906108c 14400
8e04817f
AC
14401@item --norecursion
14402Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14403propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 14404
8e04817f
AC
14405@item --target=@var{target}
14406Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14407@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14408programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 14409
8e04817f 14410There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 14411
8e04817f
AC
14412@item @var{host} @dots{}
14413Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 14414
8e04817f
AC
14415There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14416@end table
c906108c 14417
8e04817f
AC
14418There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14419needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 14420
8e04817f
AC
14421@node Maintenance Commands
14422@appendix Maintenance Commands
14423@cindex maintenance commands
14424@cindex internal commands
c906108c 14425
8e04817f
AC
14426In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14427includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14428These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 14429
8e04817f
AC
14430@table @code
14431@kindex maint info breakpoints
14432@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14433Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14434breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14435internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14436breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14437is shown:
c906108c 14438
8e04817f
AC
14439@table @code
14440@item breakpoint
14441Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 14442
8e04817f
AC
14443@item watchpoint
14444Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 14445
8e04817f
AC
14446@item longjmp
14447Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14448@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 14449
8e04817f
AC
14450@item longjmp resume
14451Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 14452
8e04817f
AC
14453@item until
14454Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 14455
8e04817f
AC
14456@item finish
14457Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 14458
8e04817f
AC
14459@item shlib events
14460Shared library events.
c906108c 14461
8e04817f 14462@end table
c906108c 14463
8d30a00d
AC
14464@kindex maint internal-error
14465@kindex maint internal-warning
14466@item maint internal-error
14467@itemx maint internal-warning
14468Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14469or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14470or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14471internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14472either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14473@value{GDBN} session.
14474
14475@smallexample
14476(gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14477@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14478A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14479debugging may prove unreliable.
14480Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14481Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14482(gdb)
14483@end smallexample
14484
14485Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14486warning message.
14487
0680b120
AC
14488@kindex maint print registers
14489@kindex maint print raw-registers
14490@kindex maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 14491@kindex maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
14492@item maint print registers
14493@itemx maint print raw-registers
14494@itemx maint print cooked-registers
617073a9 14495@itemx maint print register-groups
0680b120
AC
14496Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14497
617073a9
AC
14498The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14499the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
14500includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
14501@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
14502register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
14503@value{GDBN} Internals}.
0680b120
AC
14504
14505Takes an optional file parameter.
14506
617073a9
AC
14507@kindex maint print reggroups
14508@item maint print reggroups
14509Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
14510
14511Takes an optional file parameter.
14512
14513@smallexample
14514(gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
14515 Group Type
14516 general user
14517 float user
14518 all user
14519 vector user
14520 system user
14521 save internal
14522 restore internal
14523@end smallexample
14524
e7ba9c65
DJ
14525@kindex maint set profile
14526@kindex maint show profile
14527@cindex profiling GDB
14528@item maint set profile
14529@itemx maint show profile
14530Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
14531
14532Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
14533command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
14534collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
14535exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
14536if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
14537(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
14538data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
14539
14540Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
14541compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
14542
8e04817f 14543@end table
c906108c 14544
c906108c 14545
e0ce93ac 14546@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 14547@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 14548
ee2d5c50
AC
14549@menu
14550* Overview::
14551* Packets::
14552* Stop Reply Packets::
14553* General Query Packets::
14554* Register Packet Format::
14555* Examples::
14556@end menu
14557
14558@node Overview
14559@section Overview
14560
8e04817f
AC
14561There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14562protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14563machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14564recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 14565
d2c6833e 14566In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
8e04817f 14567transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14568
8e04817f
AC
14569@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14570@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14571@cindex remote serial protocol
14572All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14573sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14574@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14575@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14576
474c8240 14577@smallexample
8e04817f 14578@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14579@end smallexample
8e04817f 14580@noindent
c906108c 14581
8e04817f
AC
14582@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14583@noindent
14584The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14585characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14586eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14587
8e04817f
AC
14588Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14589specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14590
474c8240 14591@smallexample
8e04817f 14592@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
474c8240 14593@end smallexample
c906108c 14594
8e04817f
AC
14595@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14596@noindent
14597That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14598has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14599since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14600
8e04817f
AC
14601@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14602When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14603response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14604the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14605retransmission):
c906108c 14606
474c8240 14607@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
14608-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14609<- @code{+}
474c8240 14610@end smallexample
8e04817f 14611@noindent
53a5351d 14612
8e04817f
AC
14613The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14614debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14615the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14616when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14617
8e04817f
AC
14618@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14619exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14620exceptions).
c906108c 14621
8e04817f 14622Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
ee2d5c50 14623@cindex remote protocol, field separator
8e04817f 14624@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
ee2d5c50 14625@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14626
8e04817f
AC
14627Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14628@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14629would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14630
8e04817f
AC
14631Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14632means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14633which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14634@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14635where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14636characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14637value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14638
8e04817f
AC
14639Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14640loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14641character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14642
8e04817f 14643So:
474c8240 14644@smallexample
8e04817f 14645"@code{0* }"
474c8240 14646@end smallexample
8e04817f
AC
14647@noindent
14648means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14649
8e04817f
AC
14650The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14651error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14652
8e04817f
AC
14653For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14654(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14655protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14656on that response.
c906108c 14657
8e04817f
AC
14658A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14659@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14660optional.
c906108c 14661
ee2d5c50
AC
14662@node Packets
14663@section Packets
14664
14665The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14666@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14667
14668@table @r
14669
14670@item @code{!} --- extended mode
14671@cindex @code{!} packet
14672
8e04817f
AC
14673Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14674persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14675debugged.
ee2d5c50
AC
14676
14677Reply:
14678@table @samp
14679@item OK
8e04817f 14680The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
ee2d5c50 14681@end table
c906108c 14682
ee2d5c50
AC
14683@item @code{?} --- last signal
14684@cindex @code{?} packet
c906108c 14685
ee2d5c50
AC
14686Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14687step and continue.
c906108c 14688
ee2d5c50
AC
14689Reply:
14690@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14691
14692@item @code{a} --- reserved
14693
14694Reserved for future use.
14695
14696@item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14697@cindex @code{A} packet
c906108c 14698
8e04817f
AC
14699Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14700specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14701See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14702
14703Reply:
14704@table @samp
14705@item OK
14706@item E@var{NN}
14707@end table
14708
14709@item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14710@cindex @code{b} packet
14711
14712Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14713
14714JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14715received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14716problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14717
14718Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14719it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14720some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14721switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14722of view, nothing actually happened.}
14723
14724@item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14725@cindex @code{B} packet
14726
8e04817f 14727Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
2f870471
AC
14728breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14729
14730This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14731(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
c906108c 14732
ee2d5c50
AC
14733@item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14734@cindex @code{c} packet
14735
14736@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
8e04817f 14737current address.
c906108c 14738
ee2d5c50
AC
14739Reply:
14740@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14741
14742@item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14743@cindex @code{C} packet
14744
8e04817f
AC
14745Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14746@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
c906108c 14747
ee2d5c50
AC
14748Reply:
14749@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
c906108c 14750
ee2d5c50
AC
14751@item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14752@cindex @code{d} packet
14753
14754Toggle debug flag.
14755
14756@item @code{D} --- detach
14757@cindex @code{D} packet
14758
14759Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
14760before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14761
14762Reply:
14763@table @samp
14764@item @emph{no response}
8e04817f 14765@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
ee2d5c50 14766@end table
c906108c 14767
ee2d5c50 14768@item @code{e} --- reserved
c906108c 14769
ee2d5c50 14770Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14771
ee2d5c50 14772@item @code{E} --- reserved
c906108c 14773
ee2d5c50 14774Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14775
ee2d5c50
AC
14776@item @code{f} --- reserved
14777
14778Reserved for future use.
14779
14780@item @code{F} --- reserved
14781
14782Reserved for future use.
14783
14784@item @code{g} --- read registers
14785@anchor{read registers packet}
14786@cindex @code{g} packet
14787
14788Read general registers.
14789
14790Reply:
14791@table @samp
14792@item @var{XX@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
14793Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14794with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14795each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
ee2d5c50
AC
14796determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
14797and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
8e04817f 14798@code{g} packets is specified below.
ee2d5c50
AC
14799@item E@var{NN}
14800for an error.
14801@end table
c906108c 14802
ee2d5c50
AC
14803@item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
14804@cindex @code{G} packet
c906108c 14805
ee2d5c50
AC
14806@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
14807data.
14808
14809Reply:
14810@table @samp
14811@item OK
14812for success
14813@item E@var{NN}
14814for an error
14815@end table
14816
14817@item @code{h} --- reserved
14818
14819Reserved for future use.
14820
14821@item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
14822@cindex @code{H} packet
c906108c 14823
8e04817f 14824Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
ee2d5c50
AC
14825@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
14826should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
14827operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
14828the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
14829
14830Reply:
14831@table @samp
14832@item OK
14833for success
14834@item E@var{NN}
14835for an error
14836@end table
c906108c 14837
8e04817f
AC
14838@c FIXME: JTC:
14839@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14840@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14841@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14842@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14843@c described. For example:
14844@c
14845@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14846@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14847@c otherwise returns current registers.
14848@c
14849@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14850@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14851@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14852
ee2d5c50
AC
14853@item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14854@anchor{cycle step packet}
14855@cindex @code{i} packet
14856
8e04817f
AC
14857Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14858present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14859step starting at that address.
c906108c 14860
ee2d5c50
AC
14861@item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14862@cindex @code{I} packet
14863
14864@xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
14865
14866@item @code{j} --- reserved
14867
14868Reserved for future use.
14869
14870@item @code{J} --- reserved
c906108c 14871
ee2d5c50 14872Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14873
ee2d5c50
AC
14874@item @code{k} --- kill request
14875@cindex @code{k} packet
c906108c 14876
ac282366 14877FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
ee2d5c50
AC
14878thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
14879thread?)}.
c906108c 14880
ee2d5c50 14881@item @code{K} --- reserved
c906108c 14882
ee2d5c50
AC
14883Reserved for future use.
14884
14885@item @code{l} --- reserved
14886
14887Reserved for future use.
14888
14889@item @code{L} --- reserved
14890
14891Reserved for future use.
14892
14893@item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
14894@cindex @code{m} packet
c906108c 14895
8e04817f 14896Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50 14897Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
2e834e49 14898assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
8e04817f 14899transfer mechanism is needed.}
c906108c 14900
ee2d5c50
AC
14901Reply:
14902@table @samp
14903@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14904@var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14905to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
2e834e49 14906that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
ee2d5c50
AC
14907accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
14908needed.}
14909@item E@var{NN}
14910@var{NN} is errno
14911@end table
14912
14913@item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
14914@cindex @code{M} packet
14915
8e04817f 14916Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
ee2d5c50
AC
14917@var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
14918
14919Reply:
14920@table @samp
14921@item OK
14922for success
14923@item E@var{NN}
8e04817f
AC
14924for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14925written).
ee2d5c50 14926@end table
c906108c 14927
ee2d5c50 14928@item @code{n} --- reserved
c906108c 14929
ee2d5c50 14930Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14931
ee2d5c50 14932@item @code{N} --- reserved
c906108c 14933
ee2d5c50 14934Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14935
ee2d5c50
AC
14936@item @code{o} --- reserved
14937
14938Reserved for future use.
14939
14940@item @code{O} --- reserved
14941
14942Reserved for future use.
c906108c 14943
ee2d5c50
AC
14944@item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14945@cindex @code{p} packet
14946
14947@xref{write register packet}.
14948
14949Reply:
14950@table @samp
14951@item @var{r@dots{}.}
14952The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14953@end table
14954
14955@item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
14956@anchor{write register packet}
14957@cindex @code{P} packet
14958
14959Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
8e04817f 14960digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
c906108c 14961
ee2d5c50
AC
14962Reply:
14963@table @samp
14964@item OK
14965for success
14966@item E@var{NN}
14967for an error
14968@end table
14969
14970@item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
14971@anchor{general query packet}
14972@cindex @code{q} packet
14973
14974Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
14975leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
14976prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
14977be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
14978that they match the full @var{query} name.
14979
14980Reply:
14981@table @samp
14982@item @var{XX@dots{}}
14983Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14984@item E@var{NN}
14985error reply
8e04817f 14986@item
ee2d5c50
AC
14987Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14988@end table
14989
14990@item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
14991@cindex @code{Q} packet
14992
14993Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
14994
14995@xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
c906108c 14996
ee2d5c50
AC
14997@item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14998@cindex @code{r} packet
c906108c 14999
8e04817f 15000Reset the entire system.
c906108c 15001
ee2d5c50
AC
15002@item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
15003@cindex @code{R} packet
15004
8e04817f
AC
15005Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
15006This packet is only available in extended mode.
ee2d5c50
AC
15007
15008Reply:
15009@table @samp
15010@item @emph{no reply}
8e04817f 15011The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
ee2d5c50
AC
15012@end table
15013
15014@item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
15015@cindex @code{s} packet
c906108c 15016
8e04817f
AC
15017@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
15018same address.
c906108c 15019
ee2d5c50
AC
15020Reply:
15021@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15022
15023@item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
15024@anchor{step with signal packet}
15025@cindex @code{S} packet
15026
8e04817f 15027Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
c906108c 15028
ee2d5c50
AC
15029Reply:
15030@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15031
15032@item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
15033@cindex @code{t} packet
15034
8e04817f 15035Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
ee2d5c50
AC
15036@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
15037@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 15038
ee2d5c50
AC
15039@item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
15040@cindex @code{T} packet
c906108c 15041
ee2d5c50 15042Find out if the thread XX is alive.
c906108c 15043
ee2d5c50
AC
15044Reply:
15045@table @samp
15046@item OK
15047thread is still alive
15048@item E@var{NN}
15049thread is dead
15050@end table
15051
15052@item @code{u} --- reserved
15053
15054Reserved for future use.
15055
15056@item @code{U} --- reserved
15057
15058Reserved for future use.
15059
15060@item @code{v} --- reserved
15061
15062Reserved for future use.
15063
15064@item @code{V} --- reserved
c906108c 15065
ee2d5c50 15066Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15067
ee2d5c50 15068@item @code{w} --- reserved
c906108c 15069
ee2d5c50 15070Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15071
ee2d5c50 15072@item @code{W} --- reserved
c906108c 15073
ee2d5c50 15074Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15075
ee2d5c50
AC
15076@item @code{x} --- reserved
15077
15078Reserved for future use.
15079
15080@item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
15081@cindex @code{X} packet
15082
15083@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
15084is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
8e04817f 15085escaped using @code{0x7d}.
c906108c 15086
ee2d5c50
AC
15087Reply:
15088@table @samp
15089@item OK
15090for success
15091@item E@var{NN}
15092for an error
15093@end table
15094
15095@item @code{y} --- reserved
c906108c 15096
ee2d5c50 15097Reserved for future use.
c906108c 15098
ee2d5c50
AC
15099@item @code{Y} reserved
15100
15101Reserved for future use.
15102
2f870471
AC
15103@item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15104@itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15105@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
ee2d5c50 15106@cindex @code{z} packet
2f870471 15107@cindex @code{Z} packets
ee2d5c50 15108
2f870471
AC
15109Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
15110watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
15111@var{length} bytes.
ee2d5c50 15112
2f870471
AC
15113Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
15114separately.
15115
512217c7
AC
15116@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
15117for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
15118remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
2f870471
AC
15119@code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
15120avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
15121be implemented in an idempotent way.}
15122
15123@item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15124@item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15125@cindex @code{z0} packet
15126@cindex @code{Z0} packet
15127
15128Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
15129@code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15130
15131A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
15132@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
15133@code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
15134breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
15135@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
c906108c 15136
2f870471
AC
15137@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
15138code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
15139overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
15140target, is not defined.}
c906108c 15141
ee2d5c50
AC
15142Reply:
15143@table @samp
2f870471
AC
15144@item OK
15145success
15146@item
15147not supported
ee2d5c50
AC
15148@item E@var{NN}
15149for an error
2f870471
AC
15150@end table
15151
15152@item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15153@item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15154@cindex @code{z1} packet
15155@cindex @code{Z1} packet
15156
15157Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
15158address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15159
15160A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15161dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15162
15163@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15164movement.}
15165
15166Reply:
15167@table @samp
ee2d5c50 15168@item OK
2f870471
AC
15169success
15170@item
15171not supported
15172@item E@var{NN}
15173for an error
15174@end table
15175
15176@item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15177@item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15178@cindex @code{z2} packet
15179@cindex @code{Z2} packet
15180
15181Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15182
15183Reply:
15184@table @samp
15185@item OK
15186success
15187@item
15188not supported
15189@item E@var{NN}
15190for an error
15191@end table
15192
15193@item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15194@item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15195@cindex @code{z3} packet
15196@cindex @code{Z3} packet
15197
2e834e49 15198Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
2f870471
AC
15199
15200Reply:
15201@table @samp
15202@item OK
15203success
15204@item
15205not supported
15206@item E@var{NN}
15207for an error
15208@end table
15209
2e834e49
HPN
15210@item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15211@item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
2f870471
AC
15212@cindex @code{z4} packet
15213@cindex @code{Z4} packet
15214
15215Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15216
15217Reply:
15218@table @samp
15219@item OK
15220success
15221@item
15222not supported
15223@item E@var{NN}
15224for an error
ee2d5c50
AC
15225@end table
15226
15227@end table
c906108c 15228
ee2d5c50
AC
15229@node Stop Reply Packets
15230@section Stop Reply Packets
15231@cindex stop reply packets
c906108c 15232
8e04817f
AC
15233The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15234receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15235@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15236when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15237number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15238conventions is used.
c906108c 15239
ee2d5c50 15240@table @samp
c906108c 15241
ee2d5c50
AC
15242@item S@var{AA}
15243@var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 15244
8e04817f 15245@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
ee2d5c50
AC
15246@cindex @code{T} packet reply
15247
8e04817f
AC
15248@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15249(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15250by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
3c3bea1c
GS
15251thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15252@samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15253integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15254@value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15255to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
c906108c 15256
ee2d5c50
AC
15257@item W@var{AA}
15258
8e04817f 15259The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
ee2d5c50
AC
15260applicable to certain targets.
15261
15262@item X@var{AA}
c906108c 15263
8e04817f 15264The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 15265
ee2d5c50
AC
15266@item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15267
15268@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15269@code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15270base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15271The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15272the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15273is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
c906108c 15274
ee2d5c50 15275@item O@var{XX@dots{}}
c906108c 15276
ee2d5c50
AC
15277@var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15278any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15279to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15280
15281@end table
15282
15283@node General Query Packets
15284@section General Query Packets
c906108c 15285
8e04817f 15286The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 15287
ee2d5c50 15288@table @r
c906108c 15289
ee2d5c50
AC
15290@item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15291
15292Return the current thread id.
15293
15294Reply:
15295@table @samp
15296@item @code{QC}@var{pid}
8e04817f 15297Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
ee2d5c50
AC
15298@item *
15299Any other reply implies the old pid.
15300@end table
15301
15302@item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15303
15304@code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
c906108c 15305
8e04817f
AC
15306Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15307may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15308works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15309obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15310be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15311sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
ee2d5c50
AC
15312
15313NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15314
15315Reply:
15316@table @samp
15317@item @code{m}@var{id}
15318A single thread id
15319@item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15320a comma-separated list of thread ids
15321@item @code{l}
15322(lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15323@end table
15324
15325In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15326more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15327will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
8e04817f
AC
15328@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15329(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 15330
ee2d5c50
AC
15331@item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15332
15333Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15334string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15335string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15336@value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15337in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15338possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15339Mutex''.
15340
15341Reply:
15342@table @samp
15343@item @var{XX@dots{}}
15344Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15345the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
8e04817f 15346attributes.
ee2d5c50
AC
15347@end table
15348
15349@item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
c906108c 15350
8e04817f
AC
15351Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15352digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15353subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15354number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15355(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15356returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
ee2d5c50
AC
15357
15358NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15359(see above).
15360
15361Reply:
15362@table @samp
15363@item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
8e04817f
AC
15364Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15365returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15366and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
ee2d5c50
AC
15367digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15368is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
8e04817f 15369digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
ee2d5c50 15370@end table
c906108c 15371
ee2d5c50
AC
15372@item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15373
15374Reply:
15375@table @samp
15376@item @code{E}@var{NN}
15377An error (such as memory fault)
15378@item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15379A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15380@end table
15381
15382@item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
c906108c 15383
8e04817f
AC
15384Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15385image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15386response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15387offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
c906108c 15388
ee2d5c50
AC
15389Reply:
15390@table @samp
15391@item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15392@end table
15393
15394@item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15395
8e04817f
AC
15396Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15397encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
ee2d5c50
AC
15398
15399Reply:
15400@table @samp
15401@item *
15402@end table
15403
8e04817f 15404See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 15405
ee2d5c50
AC
15406@item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15407
15408@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
8e04817f
AC
15409execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15410Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
ee2d5c50
AC
15411number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15412@emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15413interpreter may have security implications}.
15414
15415Reply:
15416@table @samp
15417@item OK
8e04817f 15418A command response with no output.
ee2d5c50 15419@item @var{OUTPUT}
8e04817f 15420A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
ee2d5c50 15421@item @code{E}@var{NN}
8e04817f 15422Indicate a badly formed request.
ee2d5c50 15423@item @samp{}
8e04817f 15424When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
ee2d5c50
AC
15425@end table
15426
15427@item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
c906108c 15428
8e04817f
AC
15429Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15430requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15431
15432Reply:
15433@table @samp
15434@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15435The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15436@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15437The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15438@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15439@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15440@end table
15441
15442@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15443
15444Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15445
15446@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15447target has previously requested.
15448
15449@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15450@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15451will be empty.
15452
15453Reply:
15454@table @samp
15455@item @code{OK}
8e04817f 15456The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
ee2d5c50
AC
15457@item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15458The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15459encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15460(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15461@end table
eb12ee30 15462
ee2d5c50
AC
15463@end table
15464
15465@node Register Packet Format
15466@section Register Packet Format
eb12ee30 15467
8e04817f 15468The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
ee2d5c50
AC
15469In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15470sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15471to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15472byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15473most-significant - least-significant.
eb12ee30 15474
ee2d5c50 15475@table @r
eb12ee30 15476
8e04817f 15477@item MIPS32
ee2d5c50 15478
8e04817f
AC
15479All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1548032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15481registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 15482
8e04817f 15483@item MIPS64
ee2d5c50 15484
8e04817f
AC
15485All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15486thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15487as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 15488
ee2d5c50
AC
15489@end table
15490
15491@node Examples
15492@section Examples
eb12ee30 15493
8e04817f
AC
15494Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15495does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 15496
474c8240 15497@smallexample
d2c6833e
AC
15498-> @code{R00}
15499<- @code{+}
8e04817f 15500@emph{target restarts}
d2c6833e 15501-> @code{?}
8e04817f 15502<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15503<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15504-> @code{+}
474c8240 15505@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15506
8e04817f 15507Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 15508
474c8240 15509@smallexample
d2c6833e 15510-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
8e04817f 15511<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15512-> @code{s}
15513<- @code{+}
15514@emph{time passes}
15515<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
8e04817f 15516-> @code{+}
d2c6833e 15517-> @code{g}
8e04817f 15518<- @code{+}
d2c6833e
AC
15519<- @code{1455@dots{}}
15520-> @code{+}
474c8240 15521@end smallexample
eb12ee30 15522
aab4e0ec 15523@include gpl.texi
eb12ee30 15524
6826cf00
EZ
15525@include fdl.texi
15526
6d2ebf8b 15527@node Index
c906108c
SS
15528@unnumbered Index
15529
15530@printindex cp
15531
15532@tex
15533% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15534% meantime:
15535\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15536\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15537\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15538\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15539\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15540\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15541\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15542\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15543\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15544\page\colophon
15545% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15546@end tex
15547
c906108c 15548@bye
This page took 1.291573 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.